1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
7 @chapter Machine Descriptions
8 @cindex machine descriptions
10 A machine description has two parts: a file of instruction patterns
11 (@file{.md} file) and a C header file of macro definitions.
13 The @file{.md} file for a target machine contains a pattern for each
14 instruction that the target machine supports (or at least each instruction
15 that is worth telling the compiler about). It may also contain comments.
16 A semicolon causes the rest of the line to be a comment, unless the semicolon
17 is inside a quoted string.
19 See the next chapter for information on the C header file.
22 * Overview:: How the machine description is used.
23 * Patterns:: How to write instruction patterns.
24 * Example:: An explained example of a @code{define_insn} pattern.
25 * RTL Template:: The RTL template defines what insns match a pattern.
26 * Output Template:: The output template says how to make assembler code
28 * Output Statement:: For more generality, write C code to output
30 * Predicates:: Controlling what kinds of operands can be used
32 * Constraints:: Fine-tuning operand selection.
33 * Standard Names:: Names mark patterns to use for code generation.
34 * Pattern Ordering:: When the order of patterns makes a difference.
35 * Dependent Patterns:: Having one pattern may make you need another.
36 * Jump Patterns:: Special considerations for patterns for jump insns.
37 * Looping Patterns:: How to define patterns for special looping insns.
38 * Insn Canonicalizations::Canonicalization of Instructions
39 * Expander Definitions::Generating a sequence of several RTL insns
40 for a standard operation.
41 * Insn Splitting:: Splitting Instructions into Multiple Instructions.
42 * Including Patterns:: Including Patterns in Machine Descriptions.
43 * Peephole Definitions::Defining machine-specific peephole optimizations.
44 * Insn Attributes:: Specifying the value of attributes for generated insns.
45 * Conditional Execution::Generating @code{define_insn} patterns for
47 * Define Subst:: Generating @code{define_insn} and @code{define_expand}
48 patterns from other patterns.
49 * Constant Definitions::Defining symbolic constants that can be used in the
51 * Iterators:: Using iterators to generate patterns from a template.
55 @section Overview of How the Machine Description is Used
57 There are three main conversions that happen in the compiler:
62 The front end reads the source code and builds a parse tree.
65 The parse tree is used to generate an RTL insn list based on named
69 The insn list is matched against the RTL templates to produce assembler
74 For the generate pass, only the names of the insns matter, from either a
75 named @code{define_insn} or a @code{define_expand}. The compiler will
76 choose the pattern with the right name and apply the operands according
77 to the documentation later in this chapter, without regard for the RTL
78 template or operand constraints. Note that the names the compiler looks
79 for are hard-coded in the compiler---it will ignore unnamed patterns and
80 patterns with names it doesn't know about, but if you don't provide a
81 named pattern it needs, it will abort.
83 If a @code{define_insn} is used, the template given is inserted into the
84 insn list. If a @code{define_expand} is used, one of three things
85 happens, based on the condition logic. The condition logic may manually
86 create new insns for the insn list, say via @code{emit_insn()}, and
87 invoke @code{DONE}. For certain named patterns, it may invoke @code{FAIL} to tell the
88 compiler to use an alternate way of performing that task. If it invokes
89 neither @code{DONE} nor @code{FAIL}, the template given in the pattern
90 is inserted, as if the @code{define_expand} were a @code{define_insn}.
92 Once the insn list is generated, various optimization passes convert,
93 replace, and rearrange the insns in the insn list. This is where the
94 @code{define_split} and @code{define_peephole} patterns get used, for
97 Finally, the insn list's RTL is matched up with the RTL templates in the
98 @code{define_insn} patterns, and those patterns are used to emit the
99 final assembly code. For this purpose, each named @code{define_insn}
100 acts like it's unnamed, since the names are ignored.
103 @section Everything about Instruction Patterns
105 @cindex instruction patterns
108 Each instruction pattern contains an incomplete RTL expression, with pieces
109 to be filled in later, operand constraints that restrict how the pieces can
110 be filled in, and an output pattern or C code to generate the assembler
111 output, all wrapped up in a @code{define_insn} expression.
113 A @code{define_insn} is an RTL expression containing four or five operands:
117 An optional name. The presence of a name indicate that this instruction
118 pattern can perform a certain standard job for the RTL-generation
119 pass of the compiler. This pass knows certain names and will use
120 the instruction patterns with those names, if the names are defined
121 in the machine description.
123 The absence of a name is indicated by writing an empty string
124 where the name should go. Nameless instruction patterns are never
125 used for generating RTL code, but they may permit several simpler insns
126 to be combined later on.
128 Names that are not thus known and used in RTL-generation have no
129 effect; they are equivalent to no name at all.
131 For the purpose of debugging the compiler, you may also specify a
132 name beginning with the @samp{*} character. Such a name is used only
133 for identifying the instruction in RTL dumps; it is entirely equivalent
134 to having a nameless pattern for all other purposes.
137 The @dfn{RTL template} (@pxref{RTL Template}) is a vector of incomplete
138 RTL expressions which show what the instruction should look like. It is
139 incomplete because it may contain @code{match_operand},
140 @code{match_operator}, and @code{match_dup} expressions that stand for
141 operands of the instruction.
143 If the vector has only one element, that element is the template for the
144 instruction pattern. If the vector has multiple elements, then the
145 instruction pattern is a @code{parallel} expression containing the
149 @cindex pattern conditions
150 @cindex conditions, in patterns
151 A condition. This is a string which contains a C expression that is
152 the final test to decide whether an insn body matches this pattern.
154 @cindex named patterns and conditions
155 For a named pattern, the condition (if present) may not depend on
156 the data in the insn being matched, but only the target-machine-type
157 flags. The compiler needs to test these conditions during
158 initialization in order to learn exactly which named instructions are
159 available in a particular run.
162 For nameless patterns, the condition is applied only when matching an
163 individual insn, and only after the insn has matched the pattern's
164 recognition template. The insn's operands may be found in the vector
165 @code{operands}. For an insn where the condition has once matched, it
166 can't be used to control register allocation, for example by excluding
167 certain hard registers or hard register combinations.
170 The @dfn{output template}: a string that says how to output matching
171 insns as assembler code. @samp{%} in this string specifies where
172 to substitute the value of an operand. @xref{Output Template}.
174 When simple substitution isn't general enough, you can specify a piece
175 of C code to compute the output. @xref{Output Statement}.
178 Optionally, a vector containing the values of attributes for insns matching
179 this pattern. @xref{Insn Attributes}.
183 @section Example of @code{define_insn}
184 @cindex @code{define_insn} example
186 Here is an actual example of an instruction pattern, for the 68000/68020.
191 (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "rm"))]
195 if (TARGET_68020 || ! ADDRESS_REG_P (operands[0]))
197 return \"cmpl #0,%0\";
202 This can also be written using braced strings:
207 (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "rm"))]
210 if (TARGET_68020 || ! ADDRESS_REG_P (operands[0]))
216 This is an instruction that sets the condition codes based on the value of
217 a general operand. It has no condition, so any insn whose RTL description
218 has the form shown may be handled according to this pattern. The name
219 @samp{tstsi} means ``test a @code{SImode} value'' and tells the RTL generation
220 pass that, when it is necessary to test such a value, an insn to do so
221 can be constructed using this pattern.
223 The output control string is a piece of C code which chooses which
224 output template to return based on the kind of operand and the specific
225 type of CPU for which code is being generated.
227 @samp{"rm"} is an operand constraint. Its meaning is explained below.
230 @section RTL Template
231 @cindex RTL insn template
232 @cindex generating insns
233 @cindex insns, generating
234 @cindex recognizing insns
235 @cindex insns, recognizing
237 The RTL template is used to define which insns match the particular pattern
238 and how to find their operands. For named patterns, the RTL template also
239 says how to construct an insn from specified operands.
241 Construction involves substituting specified operands into a copy of the
242 template. Matching involves determining the values that serve as the
243 operands in the insn being matched. Both of these activities are
244 controlled by special expression types that direct matching and
245 substitution of the operands.
248 @findex match_operand
249 @item (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} @var{predicate} @var{constraint})
250 This expression is a placeholder for operand number @var{n} of
251 the insn. When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n}
252 will be substituted at this point. When matching an insn, whatever
253 appears at this position in the insn will be taken as operand
254 number @var{n}; but it must satisfy @var{predicate} or this instruction
255 pattern will not match at all.
257 Operand numbers must be chosen consecutively counting from zero in
258 each instruction pattern. There may be only one @code{match_operand}
259 expression in the pattern for each operand number. Usually operands
260 are numbered in the order of appearance in @code{match_operand}
261 expressions. In the case of a @code{define_expand}, any operand numbers
262 used only in @code{match_dup} expressions have higher values than all
263 other operand numbers.
265 @var{predicate} is a string that is the name of a function that
266 accepts two arguments, an expression and a machine mode.
267 @xref{Predicates}. During matching, the function will be called with
268 the putative operand as the expression and @var{m} as the mode
269 argument (if @var{m} is not specified, @code{VOIDmode} will be used,
270 which normally causes @var{predicate} to accept any mode). If it
271 returns zero, this instruction pattern fails to match.
272 @var{predicate} may be an empty string; then it means no test is to be
273 done on the operand, so anything which occurs in this position is
276 Most of the time, @var{predicate} will reject modes other than @var{m}---but
277 not always. For example, the predicate @code{address_operand} uses
278 @var{m} as the mode of memory ref that the address should be valid for.
279 Many predicates accept @code{const_int} nodes even though their mode is
282 @var{constraint} controls reloading and the choice of the best register
283 class to use for a value, as explained later (@pxref{Constraints}).
284 If the constraint would be an empty string, it can be omitted.
286 People are often unclear on the difference between the constraint and the
287 predicate. The predicate helps decide whether a given insn matches the
288 pattern. The constraint plays no role in this decision; instead, it
289 controls various decisions in the case of an insn which does match.
291 @findex match_scratch
292 @item (match_scratch:@var{m} @var{n} @var{constraint})
293 This expression is also a placeholder for operand number @var{n}
294 and indicates that operand must be a @code{scratch} or @code{reg}
297 When matching patterns, this is equivalent to
300 (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} "scratch_operand" @var{pred})
303 but, when generating RTL, it produces a (@code{scratch}:@var{m})
306 If the last few expressions in a @code{parallel} are @code{clobber}
307 expressions whose operands are either a hard register or
308 @code{match_scratch}, the combiner can add or delete them when
309 necessary. @xref{Side Effects}.
312 @item (match_dup @var{n})
313 This expression is also a placeholder for operand number @var{n}.
314 It is used when the operand needs to appear more than once in the
317 In construction, @code{match_dup} acts just like @code{match_operand}:
318 the operand is substituted into the insn being constructed. But in
319 matching, @code{match_dup} behaves differently. It assumes that operand
320 number @var{n} has already been determined by a @code{match_operand}
321 appearing earlier in the recognition template, and it matches only an
322 identical-looking expression.
324 Note that @code{match_dup} should not be used to tell the compiler that
325 a particular register is being used for two operands (example:
326 @code{add} that adds one register to another; the second register is
327 both an input operand and the output operand). Use a matching
328 constraint (@pxref{Simple Constraints}) for those. @code{match_dup} is for the cases where one
329 operand is used in two places in the template, such as an instruction
330 that computes both a quotient and a remainder, where the opcode takes
331 two input operands but the RTL template has to refer to each of those
332 twice; once for the quotient pattern and once for the remainder pattern.
334 @findex match_operator
335 @item (match_operator:@var{m} @var{n} @var{predicate} [@var{operands}@dots{}])
336 This pattern is a kind of placeholder for a variable RTL expression
339 When constructing an insn, it stands for an RTL expression whose
340 expression code is taken from that of operand @var{n}, and whose
341 operands are constructed from the patterns @var{operands}.
343 When matching an expression, it matches an expression if the function
344 @var{predicate} returns nonzero on that expression @emph{and} the
345 patterns @var{operands} match the operands of the expression.
347 Suppose that the function @code{commutative_operator} is defined as
348 follows, to match any expression whose operator is one of the
349 commutative arithmetic operators of RTL and whose mode is @var{mode}:
353 commutative_integer_operator (x, mode)
355 enum machine_mode mode;
357 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
358 if (GET_MODE (x) != mode)
360 return (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == RTX_COMM_ARITH
361 || code == EQ || code == NE);
365 Then the following pattern will match any RTL expression consisting
366 of a commutative operator applied to two general operands:
369 (match_operator:SI 3 "commutative_operator"
370 [(match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "g")
371 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "g")])
374 Here the vector @code{[@var{operands}@dots{}]} contains two patterns
375 because the expressions to be matched all contain two operands.
377 When this pattern does match, the two operands of the commutative
378 operator are recorded as operands 1 and 2 of the insn. (This is done
379 by the two instances of @code{match_operand}.) Operand 3 of the insn
380 will be the entire commutative expression: use @code{GET_CODE
381 (operands[3])} to see which commutative operator was used.
383 The machine mode @var{m} of @code{match_operator} works like that of
384 @code{match_operand}: it is passed as the second argument to the
385 predicate function, and that function is solely responsible for
386 deciding whether the expression to be matched ``has'' that mode.
388 When constructing an insn, argument 3 of the gen-function will specify
389 the operation (i.e.@: the expression code) for the expression to be
390 made. It should be an RTL expression, whose expression code is copied
391 into a new expression whose operands are arguments 1 and 2 of the
392 gen-function. The subexpressions of argument 3 are not used;
393 only its expression code matters.
395 When @code{match_operator} is used in a pattern for matching an insn,
396 it usually best if the operand number of the @code{match_operator}
397 is higher than that of the actual operands of the insn. This improves
398 register allocation because the register allocator often looks at
399 operands 1 and 2 of insns to see if it can do register tying.
401 There is no way to specify constraints in @code{match_operator}. The
402 operand of the insn which corresponds to the @code{match_operator}
403 never has any constraints because it is never reloaded as a whole.
404 However, if parts of its @var{operands} are matched by
405 @code{match_operand} patterns, those parts may have constraints of
409 @item (match_op_dup:@var{m} @var{n}[@var{operands}@dots{}])
410 Like @code{match_dup}, except that it applies to operators instead of
411 operands. When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n} will be
412 substituted at this point. But in matching, @code{match_op_dup} behaves
413 differently. It assumes that operand number @var{n} has already been
414 determined by a @code{match_operator} appearing earlier in the
415 recognition template, and it matches only an identical-looking
418 @findex match_parallel
419 @item (match_parallel @var{n} @var{predicate} [@var{subpat}@dots{}])
420 This pattern is a placeholder for an insn that consists of a
421 @code{parallel} expression with a variable number of elements. This
422 expression should only appear at the top level of an insn pattern.
424 When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n} will be substituted at
425 this point. When matching an insn, it matches if the body of the insn
426 is a @code{parallel} expression with at least as many elements as the
427 vector of @var{subpat} expressions in the @code{match_parallel}, if each
428 @var{subpat} matches the corresponding element of the @code{parallel},
429 @emph{and} the function @var{predicate} returns nonzero on the
430 @code{parallel} that is the body of the insn. It is the responsibility
431 of the predicate to validate elements of the @code{parallel} beyond
432 those listed in the @code{match_parallel}.
434 A typical use of @code{match_parallel} is to match load and store
435 multiple expressions, which can contain a variable number of elements
436 in a @code{parallel}. For example,
440 [(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
441 [(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
442 (match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
444 (clobber (reg:SI 179))])]
449 This example comes from @file{a29k.md}. The function
450 @code{load_multiple_operation} is defined in @file{a29k.c} and checks
451 that subsequent elements in the @code{parallel} are the same as the
452 @code{set} in the pattern, except that they are referencing subsequent
453 registers and memory locations.
455 An insn that matches this pattern might look like:
459 [(set (reg:SI 20) (mem:SI (reg:SI 100)))
461 (clobber (reg:SI 179))
463 (mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI 100)
466 (mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI 100)
470 @findex match_par_dup
471 @item (match_par_dup @var{n} [@var{subpat}@dots{}])
472 Like @code{match_op_dup}, but for @code{match_parallel} instead of
473 @code{match_operator}.
477 @node Output Template
478 @section Output Templates and Operand Substitution
479 @cindex output templates
480 @cindex operand substitution
482 @cindex @samp{%} in template
484 The @dfn{output template} is a string which specifies how to output the
485 assembler code for an instruction pattern. Most of the template is a
486 fixed string which is output literally. The character @samp{%} is used
487 to specify where to substitute an operand; it can also be used to
488 identify places where different variants of the assembler require
491 In the simplest case, a @samp{%} followed by a digit @var{n} says to output
492 operand @var{n} at that point in the string.
494 @samp{%} followed by a letter and a digit says to output an operand in an
495 alternate fashion. Four letters have standard, built-in meanings described
496 below. The machine description macro @code{PRINT_OPERAND} can define
497 additional letters with nonstandard meanings.
499 @samp{%c@var{digit}} can be used to substitute an operand that is a
500 constant value without the syntax that normally indicates an immediate
503 @samp{%n@var{digit}} is like @samp{%c@var{digit}} except that the value of
504 the constant is negated before printing.
506 @samp{%a@var{digit}} can be used to substitute an operand as if it were a
507 memory reference, with the actual operand treated as the address. This may
508 be useful when outputting a ``load address'' instruction, because often the
509 assembler syntax for such an instruction requires you to write the operand
510 as if it were a memory reference.
512 @samp{%l@var{digit}} is used to substitute a @code{label_ref} into a jump
515 @samp{%=} outputs a number which is unique to each instruction in the
516 entire compilation. This is useful for making local labels to be
517 referred to more than once in a single template that generates multiple
518 assembler instructions.
520 @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character specifies a substitution that
521 does not use an operand. Only one case is standard: @samp{%%} outputs a
522 @samp{%} into the assembler code. Other nonstandard cases can be
523 defined in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. You must also define
524 which punctuation characters are valid with the
525 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} macro.
529 The template may generate multiple assembler instructions. Write the text
530 for the instructions, with @samp{\;} between them.
532 @cindex matching operands
533 When the RTL contains two operands which are required by constraint to match
534 each other, the output template must refer only to the lower-numbered operand.
535 Matching operands are not always identical, and the rest of the compiler
536 arranges to put the proper RTL expression for printing into the lower-numbered
539 One use of nonstandard letters or punctuation following @samp{%} is to
540 distinguish between different assembler languages for the same machine; for
541 example, Motorola syntax versus MIT syntax for the 68000. Motorola syntax
542 requires periods in most opcode names, while MIT syntax does not. For
543 example, the opcode @samp{movel} in MIT syntax is @samp{move.l} in Motorola
544 syntax. The same file of patterns is used for both kinds of output syntax,
545 but the character sequence @samp{%.} is used in each place where Motorola
546 syntax wants a period. The @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro for Motorola syntax
547 defines the sequence to output a period; the macro for MIT syntax defines
550 @cindex @code{#} in template
551 As a special case, a template consisting of the single character @code{#}
552 instructs the compiler to first split the insn, and then output the
553 resulting instructions separately. This helps eliminate redundancy in the
554 output templates. If you have a @code{define_insn} that needs to emit
555 multiple assembler instructions, and there is a matching @code{define_split}
556 already defined, then you can simply use @code{#} as the output template
557 instead of writing an output template that emits the multiple assembler
560 If the macro @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is defined, you can use construct
561 of the form @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@}} in the templates. These
562 describe multiple variants of assembler language syntax.
563 @xref{Instruction Output}.
565 @node Output Statement
566 @section C Statements for Assembler Output
567 @cindex output statements
568 @cindex C statements for assembler output
569 @cindex generating assembler output
571 Often a single fixed template string cannot produce correct and efficient
572 assembler code for all the cases that are recognized by a single
573 instruction pattern. For example, the opcodes may depend on the kinds of
574 operands; or some unfortunate combinations of operands may require extra
575 machine instructions.
577 If the output control string starts with a @samp{@@}, then it is actually
578 a series of templates, each on a separate line. (Blank lines and
579 leading spaces and tabs are ignored.) The templates correspond to the
580 pattern's constraint alternatives (@pxref{Multi-Alternative}). For example,
581 if a target machine has a two-address add instruction @samp{addr} to add
582 into a register and another @samp{addm} to add a register to memory, you
583 might write this pattern:
586 (define_insn "addsi3"
587 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
588 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0,0")
589 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "g,r")))]
596 @cindex @code{*} in template
597 @cindex asterisk in template
598 If the output control string starts with a @samp{*}, then it is not an
599 output template but rather a piece of C program that should compute a
600 template. It should execute a @code{return} statement to return the
601 template-string you want. Most such templates use C string literals, which
602 require doublequote characters to delimit them. To include these
603 doublequote characters in the string, prefix each one with @samp{\}.
605 If the output control string is written as a brace block instead of a
606 double-quoted string, it is automatically assumed to be C code. In that
607 case, it is not necessary to put in a leading asterisk, or to escape the
608 doublequotes surrounding C string literals.
610 The operands may be found in the array @code{operands}, whose C data type
613 It is very common to select different ways of generating assembler code
614 based on whether an immediate operand is within a certain range. Be
615 careful when doing this, because the result of @code{INTVAL} is an
616 integer on the host machine. If the host machine has more bits in an
617 @code{int} than the target machine has in the mode in which the constant
618 will be used, then some of the bits you get from @code{INTVAL} will be
619 superfluous. For proper results, you must carefully disregard the
620 values of those bits.
622 @findex output_asm_insn
623 It is possible to output an assembler instruction and then go on to output
624 or compute more of them, using the subroutine @code{output_asm_insn}. This
625 receives two arguments: a template-string and a vector of operands. The
626 vector may be @code{operands}, or it may be another array of @code{rtx}
627 that you declare locally and initialize yourself.
629 @findex which_alternative
630 When an insn pattern has multiple alternatives in its constraints, often
631 the appearance of the assembler code is determined mostly by which alternative
632 was matched. When this is so, the C code can test the variable
633 @code{which_alternative}, which is the ordinal number of the alternative
634 that was actually satisfied (0 for the first, 1 for the second alternative,
637 For example, suppose there are two opcodes for storing zero, @samp{clrreg}
638 for registers and @samp{clrmem} for memory locations. Here is how
639 a pattern could use @code{which_alternative} to choose between them:
643 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
647 return (which_alternative == 0
648 ? "clrreg %0" : "clrmem %0");
652 The example above, where the assembler code to generate was
653 @emph{solely} determined by the alternative, could also have been specified
654 as follows, having the output control string start with a @samp{@@}:
659 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
668 If you just need a little bit of C code in one (or a few) alternatives,
669 you can use @samp{*} inside of a @samp{@@} multi-alternative template:
674 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,<,m")
679 * return stack_mem_p (operands[0]) ? \"push 0\" : \"clrmem %0\";
687 @cindex operand predicates
688 @cindex operator predicates
690 A predicate determines whether a @code{match_operand} or
691 @code{match_operator} expression matches, and therefore whether the
692 surrounding instruction pattern will be used for that combination of
693 operands. GCC has a number of machine-independent predicates, and you
694 can define machine-specific predicates as needed. By convention,
695 predicates used with @code{match_operand} have names that end in
696 @samp{_operand}, and those used with @code{match_operator} have names
697 that end in @samp{_operator}.
699 All predicates are Boolean functions (in the mathematical sense) of
700 two arguments: the RTL expression that is being considered at that
701 position in the instruction pattern, and the machine mode that the
702 @code{match_operand} or @code{match_operator} specifies. In this
703 section, the first argument is called @var{op} and the second argument
704 @var{mode}. Predicates can be called from C as ordinary two-argument
705 functions; this can be useful in output templates or other
706 machine-specific code.
708 Operand predicates can allow operands that are not actually acceptable
709 to the hardware, as long as the constraints give reload the ability to
710 fix them up (@pxref{Constraints}). However, GCC will usually generate
711 better code if the predicates specify the requirements of the machine
712 instructions as closely as possible. Reload cannot fix up operands
713 that must be constants (``immediate operands''); you must use a
714 predicate that allows only constants, or else enforce the requirement
715 in the extra condition.
717 @cindex predicates and machine modes
718 @cindex normal predicates
719 @cindex special predicates
720 Most predicates handle their @var{mode} argument in a uniform manner.
721 If @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode} (unspecified), then @var{op} can have
722 any mode. If @var{mode} is anything else, then @var{op} must have the
723 same mode, unless @var{op} is a @code{CONST_INT} or integer
724 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}. These RTL expressions always have
725 @code{VOIDmode}, so it would be counterproductive to check that their
726 mode matches. Instead, predicates that accept @code{CONST_INT} and/or
727 integer @code{CONST_DOUBLE} check that the value stored in the
728 constant will fit in the requested mode.
730 Predicates with this behavior are called @dfn{normal}.
731 @command{genrecog} can optimize the instruction recognizer based on
732 knowledge of how normal predicates treat modes. It can also diagnose
733 certain kinds of common errors in the use of normal predicates; for
734 instance, it is almost always an error to use a normal predicate
735 without specifying a mode.
737 Predicates that do something different with their @var{mode} argument
738 are called @dfn{special}. The generic predicates
739 @code{address_operand} and @code{pmode_register_operand} are special
740 predicates. @command{genrecog} does not do any optimizations or
741 diagnosis when special predicates are used.
744 * Machine-Independent Predicates:: Predicates available to all back ends.
745 * Defining Predicates:: How to write machine-specific predicate
749 @node Machine-Independent Predicates
750 @subsection Machine-Independent Predicates
751 @cindex machine-independent predicates
752 @cindex generic predicates
754 These are the generic predicates available to all back ends. They are
755 defined in @file{recog.c}. The first category of predicates allow
756 only constant, or @dfn{immediate}, operands.
758 @defun immediate_operand
759 This predicate allows any sort of constant that fits in @var{mode}.
760 It is an appropriate choice for instructions that take operands that
764 @defun const_int_operand
765 This predicate allows any @code{CONST_INT} expression that fits in
766 @var{mode}. It is an appropriate choice for an immediate operand that
767 does not allow a symbol or label.
770 @defun const_double_operand
771 This predicate accepts any @code{CONST_DOUBLE} expression that has
772 exactly @var{mode}. If @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode}, it will also
773 accept @code{CONST_INT}. It is intended for immediate floating point
778 The second category of predicates allow only some kind of machine
781 @defun register_operand
782 This predicate allows any @code{REG} or @code{SUBREG} expression that
783 is valid for @var{mode}. It is often suitable for arithmetic
784 instruction operands on a RISC machine.
787 @defun pmode_register_operand
788 This is a slight variant on @code{register_operand} which works around
789 a limitation in the machine-description reader.
792 (match_operand @var{n} "pmode_register_operand" @var{constraint})
799 (match_operand:P @var{n} "register_operand" @var{constraint})
803 would mean, if the machine-description reader accepted @samp{:P}
804 mode suffixes. Unfortunately, it cannot, because @code{Pmode} is an
805 alias for some other mode, and might vary with machine-specific
806 options. @xref{Misc}.
809 @defun scratch_operand
810 This predicate allows hard registers and @code{SCRATCH} expressions,
811 but not pseudo-registers. It is used internally by @code{match_scratch};
812 it should not be used directly.
816 The third category of predicates allow only some kind of memory reference.
818 @defun memory_operand
819 This predicate allows any valid reference to a quantity of mode
820 @var{mode} in memory, as determined by the weak form of
821 @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} (@pxref{Addressing Modes}).
824 @defun address_operand
825 This predicate is a little unusual; it allows any operand that is a
826 valid expression for the @emph{address} of a quantity of mode
827 @var{mode}, again determined by the weak form of
828 @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}. To first order, if
829 @samp{@w{(mem:@var{mode} (@var{exp}))}} is acceptable to
830 @code{memory_operand}, then @var{exp} is acceptable to
831 @code{address_operand}. Note that @var{exp} does not necessarily have
835 @defun indirect_operand
836 This is a stricter form of @code{memory_operand} which allows only
837 memory references with a @code{general_operand} as the address
838 expression. New uses of this predicate are discouraged, because
839 @code{general_operand} is very permissive, so it's hard to tell what
840 an @code{indirect_operand} does or does not allow. If a target has
841 different requirements for memory operands for different instructions,
842 it is better to define target-specific predicates which enforce the
843 hardware's requirements explicitly.
847 This predicate allows a memory reference suitable for pushing a value
848 onto the stack. This will be a @code{MEM} which refers to
849 @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, with a side-effect in its address expression
850 (@pxref{Incdec}); which one is determined by the
851 @code{STACK_PUSH_CODE} macro (@pxref{Frame Layout}).
855 This predicate allows a memory reference suitable for popping a value
856 off the stack. Again, this will be a @code{MEM} referring to
857 @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, with a side-effect in its address
858 expression. However, this time @code{STACK_POP_CODE} is expected.
862 The fourth category of predicates allow some combination of the above
865 @defun nonmemory_operand
866 This predicate allows any immediate or register operand valid for @var{mode}.
869 @defun nonimmediate_operand
870 This predicate allows any register or memory operand valid for @var{mode}.
873 @defun general_operand
874 This predicate allows any immediate, register, or memory operand
875 valid for @var{mode}.
879 Finally, there are two generic operator predicates.
881 @defun comparison_operator
882 This predicate matches any expression which performs an arithmetic
883 comparison in @var{mode}; that is, @code{COMPARISON_P} is true for the
887 @defun ordered_comparison_operator
888 This predicate matches any expression which performs an arithmetic
889 comparison in @var{mode} and whose expression code is valid for integer
890 modes; that is, the expression code will be one of @code{eq}, @code{ne},
891 @code{lt}, @code{ltu}, @code{le}, @code{leu}, @code{gt}, @code{gtu},
892 @code{ge}, @code{geu}.
895 @node Defining Predicates
896 @subsection Defining Machine-Specific Predicates
897 @cindex defining predicates
898 @findex define_predicate
899 @findex define_special_predicate
901 Many machines have requirements for their operands that cannot be
902 expressed precisely using the generic predicates. You can define
903 additional predicates using @code{define_predicate} and
904 @code{define_special_predicate} expressions. These expressions have
909 The name of the predicate, as it will be referred to in
910 @code{match_operand} or @code{match_operator} expressions.
913 An RTL expression which evaluates to true if the predicate allows the
914 operand @var{op}, false if it does not. This expression can only use
915 the following RTL codes:
919 When written inside a predicate expression, a @code{MATCH_OPERAND}
920 expression evaluates to true if the predicate it names would allow
921 @var{op}. The operand number and constraint are ignored. Due to
922 limitations in @command{genrecog}, you can only refer to generic
923 predicates and predicates that have already been defined.
926 This expression evaluates to true if @var{op} or a specified
927 subexpression of @var{op} has one of a given list of RTX codes.
929 The first operand of this expression is a string constant containing a
930 comma-separated list of RTX code names (in lower case). These are the
931 codes for which the @code{MATCH_CODE} will be true.
933 The second operand is a string constant which indicates what
934 subexpression of @var{op} to examine. If it is absent or the empty
935 string, @var{op} itself is examined. Otherwise, the string constant
936 must be a sequence of digits and/or lowercase letters. Each character
937 indicates a subexpression to extract from the current expression; for
938 the first character this is @var{op}, for the second and subsequent
939 characters it is the result of the previous character. A digit
940 @var{n} extracts @samp{@w{XEXP (@var{e}, @var{n})}}; a letter @var{l}
941 extracts @samp{@w{XVECEXP (@var{e}, 0, @var{n})}} where @var{n} is the
942 alphabetic ordinal of @var{l} (0 for `a', 1 for 'b', and so on). The
943 @code{MATCH_CODE} then examines the RTX code of the subexpression
944 extracted by the complete string. It is not possible to extract
945 components of an @code{rtvec} that is not at position 0 within its RTX
949 This expression has one operand, a string constant containing a C
950 expression. The predicate's arguments, @var{op} and @var{mode}, are
951 available with those names in the C expression. The @code{MATCH_TEST}
952 evaluates to true if the C expression evaluates to a nonzero value.
953 @code{MATCH_TEST} expressions must not have side effects.
959 The basic @samp{MATCH_} expressions can be combined using these
960 logical operators, which have the semantics of the C operators
961 @samp{&&}, @samp{||}, @samp{!}, and @samp{@w{? :}} respectively. As
962 in Common Lisp, you may give an @code{AND} or @code{IOR} expression an
963 arbitrary number of arguments; this has exactly the same effect as
964 writing a chain of two-argument @code{AND} or @code{IOR} expressions.
968 An optional block of C code, which should execute
969 @samp{@w{return true}} if the predicate is found to match and
970 @samp{@w{return false}} if it does not. It must not have any side
971 effects. The predicate arguments, @var{op} and @var{mode}, are
972 available with those names.
974 If a code block is present in a predicate definition, then the RTL
975 expression must evaluate to true @emph{and} the code block must
976 execute @samp{@w{return true}} for the predicate to allow the operand.
977 The RTL expression is evaluated first; do not re-check anything in the
978 code block that was checked in the RTL expression.
981 The program @command{genrecog} scans @code{define_predicate} and
982 @code{define_special_predicate} expressions to determine which RTX
983 codes are possibly allowed. You should always make this explicit in
984 the RTL predicate expression, using @code{MATCH_OPERAND} and
987 Here is an example of a simple predicate definition, from the IA64
992 ;; @r{True if @var{op} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} which refers to the sdata section.}
993 (define_predicate "small_addr_symbolic_operand"
994 (and (match_code "symbol_ref")
995 (match_test "SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_ADDR_P (op)")))
1000 And here is another, showing the use of the C block.
1004 ;; @r{True if @var{op} is a register operand that is (or could be) a GR reg.}
1005 (define_predicate "gr_register_operand"
1006 (match_operand 0 "register_operand")
1009 if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
1010 op = SUBREG_REG (op);
1013 return (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || GENERAL_REGNO_P (regno));
1018 Predicates written with @code{define_predicate} automatically include
1019 a test that @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode}, or @var{op} has the same
1020 mode as @var{mode}, or @var{op} is a @code{CONST_INT} or
1021 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}. They do @emph{not} check specifically for
1022 integer @code{CONST_DOUBLE}, nor do they test that the value of either
1023 kind of constant fits in the requested mode. This is because
1024 target-specific predicates that take constants usually have to do more
1025 stringent value checks anyway. If you need the exact same treatment
1026 of @code{CONST_INT} or @code{CONST_DOUBLE} that the generic predicates
1027 provide, use a @code{MATCH_OPERAND} subexpression to call
1028 @code{const_int_operand}, @code{const_double_operand}, or
1029 @code{immediate_operand}.
1031 Predicates written with @code{define_special_predicate} do not get any
1032 automatic mode checks, and are treated as having special mode handling
1033 by @command{genrecog}.
1035 The program @command{genpreds} is responsible for generating code to
1036 test predicates. It also writes a header file containing function
1037 declarations for all machine-specific predicates. It is not necessary
1038 to declare these predicates in @file{@var{cpu}-protos.h}.
1041 @c Most of this node appears by itself (in a different place) even
1042 @c when the INTERNALS flag is clear. Passages that require the internals
1043 @c manual's context are conditionalized to appear only in the internals manual.
1046 @section Operand Constraints
1047 @cindex operand constraints
1050 Each @code{match_operand} in an instruction pattern can specify
1051 constraints for the operands allowed. The constraints allow you to
1052 fine-tune matching within the set of operands allowed by the
1058 @section Constraints for @code{asm} Operands
1059 @cindex operand constraints, @code{asm}
1060 @cindex constraints, @code{asm}
1061 @cindex @code{asm} constraints
1063 Here are specific details on what constraint letters you can use with
1064 @code{asm} operands.
1066 Constraints can say whether
1067 an operand may be in a register, and which kinds of register; whether the
1068 operand can be a memory reference, and which kinds of address; whether the
1069 operand may be an immediate constant, and which possible values it may
1070 have. Constraints can also require two operands to match.
1071 Side-effects aren't allowed in operands of inline @code{asm}, unless
1072 @samp{<} or @samp{>} constraints are used, because there is no guarantee
1073 that the side-effects will happen exactly once in an instruction that can update
1074 the addressing register.
1078 * Simple Constraints:: Basic use of constraints.
1079 * Multi-Alternative:: When an insn has two alternative constraint-patterns.
1080 * Class Preferences:: Constraints guide which hard register to put things in.
1081 * Modifiers:: More precise control over effects of constraints.
1082 * Machine Constraints:: Existing constraints for some particular machines.
1083 * Disable Insn Alternatives:: Disable insn alternatives using the @code{enabled} attribute.
1084 * Define Constraints:: How to define machine-specific constraints.
1085 * C Constraint Interface:: How to test constraints from C code.
1091 * Simple Constraints:: Basic use of constraints.
1092 * Multi-Alternative:: When an insn has two alternative constraint-patterns.
1093 * Modifiers:: More precise control over effects of constraints.
1094 * Machine Constraints:: Special constraints for some particular machines.
1098 @node Simple Constraints
1099 @subsection Simple Constraints
1100 @cindex simple constraints
1102 The simplest kind of constraint is a string full of letters, each of
1103 which describes one kind of operand that is permitted. Here are
1104 the letters that are allowed:
1108 Whitespace characters are ignored and can be inserted at any position
1109 except the first. This enables each alternative for different operands to
1110 be visually aligned in the machine description even if they have different
1111 number of constraints and modifiers.
1113 @cindex @samp{m} in constraint
1114 @cindex memory references in constraints
1116 A memory operand is allowed, with any kind of address that the machine
1117 supports in general.
1118 Note that the letter used for the general memory constraint can be
1119 re-defined by a back end using the @code{TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT} macro.
1121 @cindex offsettable address
1122 @cindex @samp{o} in constraint
1124 A memory operand is allowed, but only if the address is
1125 @dfn{offsettable}. This means that adding a small integer (actually,
1126 the width in bytes of the operand, as determined by its machine mode)
1127 may be added to the address and the result is also a valid memory
1130 @cindex autoincrement/decrement addressing
1131 For example, an address which is constant is offsettable; so is an
1132 address that is the sum of a register and a constant (as long as a
1133 slightly larger constant is also within the range of address-offsets
1134 supported by the machine); but an autoincrement or autodecrement
1135 address is not offsettable. More complicated indirect/indexed
1136 addresses may or may not be offsettable depending on the other
1137 addressing modes that the machine supports.
1139 Note that in an output operand which can be matched by another
1140 operand, the constraint letter @samp{o} is valid only when accompanied
1141 by both @samp{<} (if the target machine has predecrement addressing)
1142 and @samp{>} (if the target machine has preincrement addressing).
1144 @cindex @samp{V} in constraint
1146 A memory operand that is not offsettable. In other words, anything that
1147 would fit the @samp{m} constraint but not the @samp{o} constraint.
1149 @cindex @samp{<} in constraint
1151 A memory operand with autodecrement addressing (either predecrement or
1152 postdecrement) is allowed. In inline @code{asm} this constraint is only
1153 allowed if the operand is used exactly once in an instruction that can
1154 handle the side-effects. Not using an operand with @samp{<} in constraint
1155 string in the inline @code{asm} pattern at all or using it in multiple
1156 instructions isn't valid, because the side-effects wouldn't be performed
1157 or would be performed more than once. Furthermore, on some targets
1158 the operand with @samp{<} in constraint string must be accompanied by
1159 special instruction suffixes like @code{%U0} instruction suffix on PowerPC
1160 or @code{%P0} on IA-64.
1162 @cindex @samp{>} in constraint
1164 A memory operand with autoincrement addressing (either preincrement or
1165 postincrement) is allowed. In inline @code{asm} the same restrictions
1166 as for @samp{<} apply.
1168 @cindex @samp{r} in constraint
1169 @cindex registers in constraints
1171 A register operand is allowed provided that it is in a general
1174 @cindex constants in constraints
1175 @cindex @samp{i} in constraint
1177 An immediate integer operand (one with constant value) is allowed.
1178 This includes symbolic constants whose values will be known only at
1179 assembly time or later.
1181 @cindex @samp{n} in constraint
1183 An immediate integer operand with a known numeric value is allowed.
1184 Many systems cannot support assembly-time constants for operands less
1185 than a word wide. Constraints for these operands should use @samp{n}
1186 rather than @samp{i}.
1188 @cindex @samp{I} in constraint
1189 @item @samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}
1190 Other letters in the range @samp{I} through @samp{P} may be defined in
1191 a machine-dependent fashion to permit immediate integer operands with
1192 explicit integer values in specified ranges. For example, on the
1193 68000, @samp{I} is defined to stand for the range of values 1 to 8.
1194 This is the range permitted as a shift count in the shift
1197 @cindex @samp{E} in constraint
1199 An immediate floating operand (expression code @code{const_double}) is
1200 allowed, but only if the target floating point format is the same as
1201 that of the host machine (on which the compiler is running).
1203 @cindex @samp{F} in constraint
1205 An immediate floating operand (expression code @code{const_double} or
1206 @code{const_vector}) is allowed.
1208 @cindex @samp{G} in constraint
1209 @cindex @samp{H} in constraint
1210 @item @samp{G}, @samp{H}
1211 @samp{G} and @samp{H} may be defined in a machine-dependent fashion to
1212 permit immediate floating operands in particular ranges of values.
1214 @cindex @samp{s} in constraint
1216 An immediate integer operand whose value is not an explicit integer is
1219 This might appear strange; if an insn allows a constant operand with a
1220 value not known at compile time, it certainly must allow any known
1221 value. So why use @samp{s} instead of @samp{i}? Sometimes it allows
1222 better code to be generated.
1224 For example, on the 68000 in a fullword instruction it is possible to
1225 use an immediate operand; but if the immediate value is between @minus{}128
1226 and 127, better code results from loading the value into a register and
1227 using the register. This is because the load into the register can be
1228 done with a @samp{moveq} instruction. We arrange for this to happen
1229 by defining the letter @samp{K} to mean ``any integer outside the
1230 range @minus{}128 to 127'', and then specifying @samp{Ks} in the operand
1233 @cindex @samp{g} in constraint
1235 Any register, memory or immediate integer operand is allowed, except for
1236 registers that are not general registers.
1238 @cindex @samp{X} in constraint
1241 Any operand whatsoever is allowed, even if it does not satisfy
1242 @code{general_operand}. This is normally used in the constraint of
1243 a @code{match_scratch} when certain alternatives will not actually
1244 require a scratch register.
1247 Any operand whatsoever is allowed.
1250 @cindex @samp{0} in constraint
1251 @cindex digits in constraint
1252 @item @samp{0}, @samp{1}, @samp{2}, @dots{} @samp{9}
1253 An operand that matches the specified operand number is allowed. If a
1254 digit is used together with letters within the same alternative, the
1255 digit should come last.
1257 This number is allowed to be more than a single digit. If multiple
1258 digits are encountered consecutively, they are interpreted as a single
1259 decimal integer. There is scant chance for ambiguity, since to-date
1260 it has never been desirable that @samp{10} be interpreted as matching
1261 either operand 1 @emph{or} operand 0. Should this be desired, one
1262 can use multiple alternatives instead.
1264 @cindex matching constraint
1265 @cindex constraint, matching
1266 This is called a @dfn{matching constraint} and what it really means is
1267 that the assembler has only a single operand that fills two roles
1269 considered separate in the RTL insn. For example, an add insn has two
1270 input operands and one output operand in the RTL, but on most CISC
1273 which @code{asm} distinguishes. For example, an add instruction uses
1274 two input operands and an output operand, but on most CISC
1276 machines an add instruction really has only two operands, one of them an
1277 input-output operand:
1283 Matching constraints are used in these circumstances.
1284 More precisely, the two operands that match must include one input-only
1285 operand and one output-only operand. Moreover, the digit must be a
1286 smaller number than the number of the operand that uses it in the
1290 For operands to match in a particular case usually means that they
1291 are identical-looking RTL expressions. But in a few special cases
1292 specific kinds of dissimilarity are allowed. For example, @code{*x}
1293 as an input operand will match @code{*x++} as an output operand.
1294 For proper results in such cases, the output template should always
1295 use the output-operand's number when printing the operand.
1298 @cindex load address instruction
1299 @cindex push address instruction
1300 @cindex address constraints
1301 @cindex @samp{p} in constraint
1303 An operand that is a valid memory address is allowed. This is
1304 for ``load address'' and ``push address'' instructions.
1306 @findex address_operand
1307 @samp{p} in the constraint must be accompanied by @code{address_operand}
1308 as the predicate in the @code{match_operand}. This predicate interprets
1309 the mode specified in the @code{match_operand} as the mode of the memory
1310 reference for which the address would be valid.
1312 @cindex other register constraints
1313 @cindex extensible constraints
1314 @item @var{other-letters}
1315 Other letters can be defined in machine-dependent fashion to stand for
1316 particular classes of registers or other arbitrary operand types.
1317 @samp{d}, @samp{a} and @samp{f} are defined on the 68000/68020 to stand
1318 for data, address and floating point registers.
1322 In order to have valid assembler code, each operand must satisfy
1323 its constraint. But a failure to do so does not prevent the pattern
1324 from applying to an insn. Instead, it directs the compiler to modify
1325 the code so that the constraint will be satisfied. Usually this is
1326 done by copying an operand into a register.
1328 Contrast, therefore, the two instruction patterns that follow:
1332 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r")
1333 (plus:SI (match_dup 0)
1334 (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "r")))]
1340 which has two operands, one of which must appear in two places, and
1344 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r")
1345 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
1346 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "r")))]
1352 which has three operands, two of which are required by a constraint to be
1353 identical. If we are considering an insn of the form
1356 (insn @var{n} @var{prev} @var{next}
1358 (plus:SI (reg:SI 6) (reg:SI 109)))
1363 the first pattern would not apply at all, because this insn does not
1364 contain two identical subexpressions in the right place. The pattern would
1365 say, ``That does not look like an add instruction; try other patterns''.
1366 The second pattern would say, ``Yes, that's an add instruction, but there
1367 is something wrong with it''. It would direct the reload pass of the
1368 compiler to generate additional insns to make the constraint true. The
1369 results might look like this:
1372 (insn @var{n2} @var{prev} @var{n}
1373 (set (reg:SI 3) (reg:SI 6))
1376 (insn @var{n} @var{n2} @var{next}
1378 (plus:SI (reg:SI 3) (reg:SI 109)))
1382 It is up to you to make sure that each operand, in each pattern, has
1383 constraints that can handle any RTL expression that could be present for
1384 that operand. (When multiple alternatives are in use, each pattern must,
1385 for each possible combination of operand expressions, have at least one
1386 alternative which can handle that combination of operands.) The
1387 constraints don't need to @emph{allow} any possible operand---when this is
1388 the case, they do not constrain---but they must at least point the way to
1389 reloading any possible operand so that it will fit.
1393 If the constraint accepts whatever operands the predicate permits,
1394 there is no problem: reloading is never necessary for this operand.
1396 For example, an operand whose constraints permit everything except
1397 registers is safe provided its predicate rejects registers.
1399 An operand whose predicate accepts only constant values is safe
1400 provided its constraints include the letter @samp{i}. If any possible
1401 constant value is accepted, then nothing less than @samp{i} will do;
1402 if the predicate is more selective, then the constraints may also be
1406 Any operand expression can be reloaded by copying it into a register.
1407 So if an operand's constraints allow some kind of register, it is
1408 certain to be safe. It need not permit all classes of registers; the
1409 compiler knows how to copy a register into another register of the
1410 proper class in order to make an instruction valid.
1412 @cindex nonoffsettable memory reference
1413 @cindex memory reference, nonoffsettable
1415 A nonoffsettable memory reference can be reloaded by copying the
1416 address into a register. So if the constraint uses the letter
1417 @samp{o}, all memory references are taken care of.
1420 A constant operand can be reloaded by allocating space in memory to
1421 hold it as preinitialized data. Then the memory reference can be used
1422 in place of the constant. So if the constraint uses the letters
1423 @samp{o} or @samp{m}, constant operands are not a problem.
1426 If the constraint permits a constant and a pseudo register used in an insn
1427 was not allocated to a hard register and is equivalent to a constant,
1428 the register will be replaced with the constant. If the predicate does
1429 not permit a constant and the insn is re-recognized for some reason, the
1430 compiler will crash. Thus the predicate must always recognize any
1431 objects allowed by the constraint.
1434 If the operand's predicate can recognize registers, but the constraint does
1435 not permit them, it can make the compiler crash. When this operand happens
1436 to be a register, the reload pass will be stymied, because it does not know
1437 how to copy a register temporarily into memory.
1439 If the predicate accepts a unary operator, the constraint applies to the
1440 operand. For example, the MIPS processor at ISA level 3 supports an
1441 instruction which adds two registers in @code{SImode} to produce a
1442 @code{DImode} result, but only if the registers are correctly sign
1443 extended. This predicate for the input operands accepts a
1444 @code{sign_extend} of an @code{SImode} register. Write the constraint
1445 to indicate the type of register that is required for the operand of the
1449 @node Multi-Alternative
1450 @subsection Multiple Alternative Constraints
1451 @cindex multiple alternative constraints
1453 Sometimes a single instruction has multiple alternative sets of possible
1454 operands. For example, on the 68000, a logical-or instruction can combine
1455 register or an immediate value into memory, or it can combine any kind of
1456 operand into a register; but it cannot combine one memory location into
1459 These constraints are represented as multiple alternatives. An alternative
1460 can be described by a series of letters for each operand. The overall
1461 constraint for an operand is made from the letters for this operand
1462 from the first alternative, a comma, the letters for this operand from
1463 the second alternative, a comma, and so on until the last alternative.
1465 Here is how it is done for fullword logical-or on the 68000:
1468 (define_insn "iorsi3"
1469 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=m,d")
1470 (ior:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "%0,0")
1471 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dKs,dmKs")))]
1475 The first alternative has @samp{m} (memory) for operand 0, @samp{0} for
1476 operand 1 (meaning it must match operand 0), and @samp{dKs} for operand
1477 2. The second alternative has @samp{d} (data register) for operand 0,
1478 @samp{0} for operand 1, and @samp{dmKs} for operand 2. The @samp{=} and
1479 @samp{%} in the constraints apply to all the alternatives; their
1480 meaning is explained in the next section (@pxref{Class Preferences}).
1483 @c FIXME Is this ? and ! stuff of use in asm()? If not, hide unless INTERNAL
1484 If all the operands fit any one alternative, the instruction is valid.
1485 Otherwise, for each alternative, the compiler counts how many instructions
1486 must be added to copy the operands so that that alternative applies.
1487 The alternative requiring the least copying is chosen. If two alternatives
1488 need the same amount of copying, the one that comes first is chosen.
1489 These choices can be altered with the @samp{?} and @samp{!} characters:
1492 @cindex @samp{?} in constraint
1493 @cindex question mark
1495 Disparage slightly the alternative that the @samp{?} appears in,
1496 as a choice when no alternative applies exactly. The compiler regards
1497 this alternative as one unit more costly for each @samp{?} that appears
1500 @cindex @samp{!} in constraint
1501 @cindex exclamation point
1503 Disparage severely the alternative that the @samp{!} appears in.
1504 This alternative can still be used if it fits without reloading,
1505 but if reloading is needed, some other alternative will be used.
1509 When an insn pattern has multiple alternatives in its constraints, often
1510 the appearance of the assembler code is determined mostly by which
1511 alternative was matched. When this is so, the C code for writing the
1512 assembler code can use the variable @code{which_alternative}, which is
1513 the ordinal number of the alternative that was actually satisfied (0 for
1514 the first, 1 for the second alternative, etc.). @xref{Output Statement}.
1518 @node Class Preferences
1519 @subsection Register Class Preferences
1520 @cindex class preference constraints
1521 @cindex register class preference constraints
1523 @cindex voting between constraint alternatives
1524 The operand constraints have another function: they enable the compiler
1525 to decide which kind of hardware register a pseudo register is best
1526 allocated to. The compiler examines the constraints that apply to the
1527 insns that use the pseudo register, looking for the machine-dependent
1528 letters such as @samp{d} and @samp{a} that specify classes of registers.
1529 The pseudo register is put in whichever class gets the most ``votes''.
1530 The constraint letters @samp{g} and @samp{r} also vote: they vote in
1531 favor of a general register. The machine description says which registers
1532 are considered general.
1534 Of course, on some machines all registers are equivalent, and no register
1535 classes are defined. Then none of this complexity is relevant.
1539 @subsection Constraint Modifier Characters
1540 @cindex modifiers in constraints
1541 @cindex constraint modifier characters
1543 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1544 Here are constraint modifier characters.
1547 @cindex @samp{=} in constraint
1549 Means that this operand is write-only for this instruction: the previous
1550 value is discarded and replaced by output data.
1552 @cindex @samp{+} in constraint
1554 Means that this operand is both read and written by the instruction.
1556 When the compiler fixes up the operands to satisfy the constraints,
1557 it needs to know which operands are inputs to the instruction and
1558 which are outputs from it. @samp{=} identifies an output; @samp{+}
1559 identifies an operand that is both input and output; all other operands
1560 are assumed to be input only.
1562 If you specify @samp{=} or @samp{+} in a constraint, you put it in the
1563 first character of the constraint string.
1565 @cindex @samp{&} in constraint
1566 @cindex earlyclobber operand
1568 Means (in a particular alternative) that this operand is an
1569 @dfn{earlyclobber} operand, which is modified before the instruction is
1570 finished using the input operands. Therefore, this operand may not lie
1571 in a register that is used as an input operand or as part of any memory
1574 @samp{&} applies only to the alternative in which it is written. In
1575 constraints with multiple alternatives, sometimes one alternative
1576 requires @samp{&} while others do not. See, for example, the
1577 @samp{movdf} insn of the 68000.
1579 An input operand can be tied to an earlyclobber operand if its only
1580 use as an input occurs before the early result is written. Adding
1581 alternatives of this form often allows GCC to produce better code
1582 when only some of the inputs can be affected by the earlyclobber.
1583 See, for example, the @samp{mulsi3} insn of the ARM@.
1585 @samp{&} does not obviate the need to write @samp{=}.
1587 @cindex @samp{%} in constraint
1589 Declares the instruction to be commutative for this operand and the
1590 following operand. This means that the compiler may interchange the
1591 two operands if that is the cheapest way to make all operands fit the
1594 This is often used in patterns for addition instructions
1595 that really have only two operands: the result must go in one of the
1596 arguments. Here for example, is how the 68000 halfword-add
1597 instruction is defined:
1600 (define_insn "addhi3"
1601 [(set (match_operand:HI 0 "general_operand" "=m,r")
1602 (plus:HI (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" "%0,0")
1603 (match_operand:HI 2 "general_operand" "di,g")))]
1607 GCC can only handle one commutative pair in an asm; if you use more,
1608 the compiler may fail. Note that you need not use the modifier if
1609 the two alternatives are strictly identical; this would only waste
1610 time in the reload pass. The modifier is not operational after
1611 register allocation, so the result of @code{define_peephole2}
1612 and @code{define_split}s performed after reload cannot rely on
1613 @samp{%} to make the intended insn match.
1615 @cindex @samp{#} in constraint
1617 Says that all following characters, up to the next comma, are to be
1618 ignored as a constraint. They are significant only for choosing
1619 register preferences.
1621 @cindex @samp{*} in constraint
1623 Says that the following character should be ignored when choosing
1624 register preferences. @samp{*} has no effect on the meaning of the
1625 constraint as a constraint, and no effect on reloading. For LRA
1626 @samp{*} additionally disparages slightly the alternative if the
1627 following character matches the operand.
1630 Here is an example: the 68000 has an instruction to sign-extend a
1631 halfword in a data register, and can also sign-extend a value by
1632 copying it into an address register. While either kind of register is
1633 acceptable, the constraints on an address-register destination are
1634 less strict, so it is best if register allocation makes an address
1635 register its goal. Therefore, @samp{*} is used so that the @samp{d}
1636 constraint letter (for data register) is ignored when computing
1637 register preferences.
1640 (define_insn "extendhisi2"
1641 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=*d,a")
1643 (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" "0,g")))]
1649 @node Machine Constraints
1650 @subsection Constraints for Particular Machines
1651 @cindex machine specific constraints
1652 @cindex constraints, machine specific
1654 Whenever possible, you should use the general-purpose constraint letters
1655 in @code{asm} arguments, since they will convey meaning more readily to
1656 people reading your code. Failing that, use the constraint letters
1657 that usually have very similar meanings across architectures. The most
1658 commonly used constraints are @samp{m} and @samp{r} (for memory and
1659 general-purpose registers respectively; @pxref{Simple Constraints}), and
1660 @samp{I}, usually the letter indicating the most common
1661 immediate-constant format.
1663 Each architecture defines additional constraints. These constraints
1664 are used by the compiler itself for instruction generation, as well as
1665 for @code{asm} statements; therefore, some of the constraints are not
1666 particularly useful for @code{asm}. Here is a summary of some of the
1667 machine-dependent constraints available on some particular machines;
1668 it includes both constraints that are useful for @code{asm} and
1669 constraints that aren't. The compiler source file mentioned in the
1670 table heading for each architecture is the definitive reference for
1671 the meanings of that architecture's constraints.
1674 @item AArch64 family---@file{config/aarch64/constraints.md}
1677 The stack pointer register (@code{SP})
1680 Floating point or SIMD vector register
1683 Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in an @code{ADD}
1687 Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in a @code{SUB}
1688 instruction (once negated)
1691 Integer constant that can be used with a 32-bit logical instruction
1694 Integer constant that can be used with a 64-bit logical instruction
1697 Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in a 32-bit @code{MOV}
1698 pseudo instruction. The @code{MOV} may be assembled to one of several different
1699 machine instructions depending on the value
1702 Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in a 64-bit @code{MOV}
1706 An absolute symbolic address or a label reference
1709 Floating point constant zero
1712 Integer constant zero
1715 The high part (bits 12 and upwards) of the pc-relative address of a symbol
1716 within 4GB of the instruction
1719 A memory address which uses a single base register with no offset
1722 A memory address suitable for a load/store pair instruction in SI, DI, SF and
1728 @item ARC ---@file{config/arc/constraints.md}
1731 Registers usable in ARCompact 16-bit instructions: @code{r0}-@code{r3},
1732 @code{r12}-@code{r15}. This constraint can only match when the @option{-mq}
1733 option is in effect.
1736 Registers usable as base-regs of memory addresses in ARCompact 16-bit memory
1737 instructions: @code{r0}-@code{r3}, @code{r12}-@code{r15}, @code{sp}.
1738 This constraint can only match when the @option{-mq}
1739 option is in effect.
1741 ARC FPX (dpfp) 64-bit registers. @code{D0}, @code{D1}.
1744 A signed 12-bit integer constant.
1747 constant for arithmetic/logical operations. This might be any constant
1748 that can be put into a long immediate by the assmbler or linker without
1749 involving a PIC relocation.
1752 A 3-bit unsigned integer constant.
1755 A 6-bit unsigned integer constant.
1758 One's complement of a 6-bit unsigned integer constant.
1761 Two's complement of a 6-bit unsigned integer constant.
1764 A 5-bit unsigned integer constant.
1767 A 7-bit unsigned integer constant.
1770 A 8-bit unsigned integer constant.
1773 Any const_double value.
1776 @item ARM family---@file{config/arm/constraints.md}
1779 VFP floating-point register
1782 The floating-point constant 0.0
1785 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in a data processing
1786 instruction. That is, an integer in the range 0 to 255 rotated by a
1790 Integer in the range @minus{}4095 to 4095
1793 Integer that satisfies constraint @samp{I} when inverted (ones complement)
1796 Integer that satisfies constraint @samp{I} when negated (twos complement)
1799 Integer in the range 0 to 32
1802 A memory reference where the exact address is in a single register
1803 (`@samp{m}' is preferable for @code{asm} statements)
1806 An item in the constant pool
1809 A symbol in the text segment of the current file
1812 A memory reference suitable for VFP load/store insns (reg+constant offset)
1815 A memory reference suitable for iWMMXt load/store instructions.
1818 A memory reference suitable for the ARMv4 ldrsb instruction.
1821 @item AVR family---@file{config/avr/constraints.md}
1824 Registers from r0 to r15
1827 Registers from r16 to r23
1830 Registers from r16 to r31
1833 Registers from r24 to r31. These registers can be used in @samp{adiw} command
1836 Pointer register (r26--r31)
1839 Base pointer register (r28--r31)
1842 Stack pointer register (SPH:SPL)
1845 Temporary register r0
1848 Register pair X (r27:r26)
1851 Register pair Y (r29:r28)
1854 Register pair Z (r31:r30)
1857 Constant greater than @minus{}1, less than 64
1860 Constant greater than @minus{}64, less than 1
1869 Constant that fits in 8 bits
1872 Constant integer @minus{}1
1875 Constant integer 8, 16, or 24
1881 A floating point constant 0.0
1884 A memory address based on Y or Z pointer with displacement.
1887 @item Epiphany---@file{config/epiphany/constraints.md}
1890 An unsigned 16-bit constant.
1893 An unsigned 5-bit constant.
1896 A signed 11-bit constant.
1899 A signed 11-bit constant added to @minus{}1.
1900 Can only match when the @option{-m1reg-@var{reg}} option is active.
1903 Left-shift of @minus{}1, i.e., a bit mask with a block of leading ones, the rest
1904 being a block of trailing zeroes.
1905 Can only match when the @option{-m1reg-@var{reg}} option is active.
1908 Right-shift of @minus{}1, i.e., a bit mask with a trailing block of ones, the
1909 rest being zeroes. Or to put it another way, one less than a power of two.
1910 Can only match when the @option{-m1reg-@var{reg}} option is active.
1913 Constant for arithmetic/logical operations.
1914 This is like @code{i}, except that for position independent code,
1915 no symbols / expressions needing relocations are allowed.
1918 Symbolic constant for call/jump instruction.
1921 The register class usable in short insns. This is a register class
1922 constraint, and can thus drive register allocation.
1923 This constraint won't match unless @option{-mprefer-short-insn-regs} is
1927 The the register class of registers that can be used to hold a
1928 sibcall call address. I.e., a caller-saved register.
1931 Core control register class.
1934 The register group usable in short insns.
1935 This constraint does not use a register class, so that it only
1936 passively matches suitable registers, and doesn't drive register allocation.
1940 Constant suitable for the addsi3_r pattern. This is a valid offset
1941 For byte, halfword, or word addressing.
1945 Matches the return address if it can be replaced with the link register.
1948 Matches the integer condition code register.
1951 Matches the return address if it is in a stack slot.
1954 Matches control register values to switch fp mode, which are encapsulated in
1955 @code{UNSPEC_FP_MODE}.
1958 @item CR16 Architecture---@file{config/cr16/cr16.h}
1962 Registers from r0 to r14 (registers without stack pointer)
1965 Register from r0 to r11 (all 16-bit registers)
1968 Register from r12 to r15 (all 32-bit registers)
1971 Signed constant that fits in 4 bits
1974 Signed constant that fits in 5 bits
1977 Signed constant that fits in 6 bits
1980 Unsigned constant that fits in 4 bits
1983 Signed constant that fits in 32 bits
1986 Check for 64 bits wide constants for add/sub instructions
1989 Floating point constant that is legal for store immediate
1992 @item Hewlett-Packard PA-RISC---@file{config/pa/pa.h}
1998 Floating point register
2001 Shift amount register
2004 Floating point register (deprecated)
2007 Upper floating point register (32-bit), floating point register (64-bit)
2013 Signed 11-bit integer constant
2016 Signed 14-bit integer constant
2019 Integer constant that can be deposited with a @code{zdepi} instruction
2022 Signed 5-bit integer constant
2028 Integer constant that can be loaded with a @code{ldil} instruction
2031 Integer constant whose value plus one is a power of 2
2034 Integer constant that can be used for @code{and} operations in @code{depi}
2035 and @code{extru} instructions
2044 Floating-point constant 0.0
2047 A @code{lo_sum} data-linkage-table memory operand
2050 A memory operand that can be used as the destination operand of an
2051 integer store instruction
2054 A scaled or unscaled indexed memory operand
2057 A memory operand for floating-point loads and stores
2060 A register indirect memory operand
2063 @item picoChip family---@file{picochip.h}
2069 Pointer register. A register which can be used to access memory without
2070 supplying an offset. Any other register can be used to access memory,
2071 but will need a constant offset. In the case of the offset being zero,
2072 it is more efficient to use a pointer register, since this reduces code
2076 A twin register. A register which may be paired with an adjacent
2077 register to create a 32-bit register.
2080 Any absolute memory address (e.g., symbolic constant, symbolic
2084 4-bit signed integer.
2087 4-bit unsigned integer.
2090 8-bit signed integer.
2093 Any constant whose absolute value is no greater than 4-bits.
2096 10-bit signed integer
2099 16-bit signed integer.
2103 @item PowerPC and IBM RS6000---@file{config/rs6000/constraints.md}
2106 Address base register
2109 Floating point register (containing 64-bit value)
2112 Floating point register (containing 32-bit value)
2115 Altivec vector register
2118 Any VSX register if the -mvsx option was used or NO_REGS.
2121 VSX vector register to hold vector double data or NO_REGS.
2124 VSX vector register to hold vector float data or NO_REGS.
2127 If @option{-mmfpgpr} was used, a floating point register or NO_REGS.
2130 Floating point register if the LFIWAX instruction is enabled or NO_REGS.
2133 VSX register if direct move instructions are enabled, or NO_REGS.
2136 No register (NO_REGS).
2139 General purpose register if 64-bit instructions are enabled or NO_REGS.
2142 VSX vector register to hold scalar double values or NO_REGS.
2145 VSX vector register to hold 128 bit integer or NO_REGS.
2148 Altivec register to use for float/32-bit int loads/stores or NO_REGS.
2151 Altivec register to use for double loads/stores or NO_REGS.
2154 FP or VSX register to perform float operations under @option{-mvsx} or NO_REGS.
2157 Floating point register if the STFIWX instruction is enabled or NO_REGS.
2160 VSX vector register to hold scalar float values or NO_REGS.
2163 Floating point register if the LFIWZX instruction is enabled or NO_REGS.
2166 A memory address that will work with the @code{lq} and @code{stq}
2170 @samp{MQ}, @samp{CTR}, or @samp{LINK} register
2179 @samp{LINK} register
2182 @samp{CR} register (condition register) number 0
2185 @samp{CR} register (condition register)
2188 @samp{XER[CA]} carry bit (part of the XER register)
2191 Signed 16-bit constant
2194 Unsigned 16-bit constant shifted left 16 bits (use @samp{L} instead for
2195 @code{SImode} constants)
2198 Unsigned 16-bit constant
2201 Signed 16-bit constant shifted left 16 bits
2204 Constant larger than 31
2213 Constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit constant
2216 Floating point constant that can be loaded into a register with one
2217 instruction per word
2220 Integer/Floating point constant that can be loaded into a register using
2225 Normally, @code{m} does not allow addresses that update the base register.
2226 If @samp{<} or @samp{>} constraint is also used, they are allowed and
2227 therefore on PowerPC targets in that case it is only safe
2228 to use @samp{m<>} in an @code{asm} statement if that @code{asm} statement
2229 accesses the operand exactly once. The @code{asm} statement must also
2230 use @samp{%U@var{<opno>}} as a placeholder for the ``update'' flag in the
2231 corresponding load or store instruction. For example:
2234 asm ("st%U0 %1,%0" : "=m<>" (mem) : "r" (val));
2240 asm ("st %1,%0" : "=m<>" (mem) : "r" (val));
2246 A ``stable'' memory operand; that is, one which does not include any
2247 automodification of the base register. This used to be useful when
2248 @samp{m} allowed automodification of the base register, but as those are now only
2249 allowed when @samp{<} or @samp{>} is used, @samp{es} is basically the same
2250 as @samp{m} without @samp{<} and @samp{>}.
2253 Memory operand that is an offset from a register (it is usually better
2254 to use @samp{m} or @samp{es} in @code{asm} statements)
2257 Memory operand that is an indexed or indirect from a register (it is
2258 usually better to use @samp{m} or @samp{es} in @code{asm} statements)
2264 Address operand that is an indexed or indirect from a register (@samp{p} is
2265 preferable for @code{asm} statements)
2268 Constant suitable as a 64-bit mask operand
2271 Constant suitable as a 32-bit mask operand
2274 System V Release 4 small data area reference
2277 AND masks that can be performed by two rldic@{l, r@} instructions
2280 Vector constant that does not require memory
2283 Vector constant that is all zeros.
2287 @item Intel 386---@file{config/i386/constraints.md}
2290 Legacy register---the eight integer registers available on all
2291 i386 processors (@code{a}, @code{b}, @code{c}, @code{d},
2292 @code{si}, @code{di}, @code{bp}, @code{sp}).
2295 Any register accessible as @code{@var{r}l}. In 32-bit mode, @code{a},
2296 @code{b}, @code{c}, and @code{d}; in 64-bit mode, any integer register.
2299 Any register accessible as @code{@var{r}h}: @code{a}, @code{b},
2300 @code{c}, and @code{d}.
2304 Any register that can be used as the index in a base+index memory
2305 access: that is, any general register except the stack pointer.
2309 The @code{a} register.
2312 The @code{b} register.
2315 The @code{c} register.
2318 The @code{d} register.
2321 The @code{si} register.
2324 The @code{di} register.
2327 The @code{a} and @code{d} registers. This class is used for instructions
2328 that return double word results in the @code{ax:dx} register pair. Single
2329 word values will be allocated either in @code{ax} or @code{dx}.
2330 For example on i386 the following implements @code{rdtsc}:
2333 unsigned long long rdtsc (void)
2335 unsigned long long tick;
2336 __asm__ __volatile__("rdtsc":"=A"(tick));
2341 This is not correct on x86_64 as it would allocate tick in either @code{ax}
2342 or @code{dx}. You have to use the following variant instead:
2345 unsigned long long rdtsc (void)
2347 unsigned int tickl, tickh;
2348 __asm__ __volatile__("rdtsc":"=a"(tickl),"=d"(tickh));
2349 return ((unsigned long long)tickh << 32)|tickl;
2355 Any 80387 floating-point (stack) register.
2358 Top of 80387 floating-point stack (@code{%st(0)}).
2361 Second from top of 80387 floating-point stack (@code{%st(1)}).
2370 First SSE register (@code{%xmm0}).
2374 Any SSE register, when SSE2 is enabled.
2377 Any SSE register, when SSE2 and inter-unit moves are enabled.
2380 Any MMX register, when inter-unit moves are enabled.
2384 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 31, for 32-bit shifts.
2387 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 63, for 64-bit shifts.
2390 Signed 8-bit integer constant.
2393 @code{0xFF} or @code{0xFFFF}, for andsi as a zero-extending move.
2396 0, 1, 2, or 3 (shifts for the @code{lea} instruction).
2399 Unsigned 8-bit integer constant (for @code{in} and @code{out}
2404 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 127, for 128-bit shifts.
2408 Standard 80387 floating point constant.
2411 Standard SSE floating point constant.
2414 32-bit signed integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
2415 to fit that range (for immediate operands in sign-extending x86-64
2419 32-bit unsigned integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
2420 to fit that range (for immediate operands in zero-extending x86-64
2425 @item Intel IA-64---@file{config/ia64/ia64.h}
2428 General register @code{r0} to @code{r3} for @code{addl} instruction
2434 Predicate register (@samp{c} as in ``conditional'')
2437 Application register residing in M-unit
2440 Application register residing in I-unit
2443 Floating-point register
2446 Memory operand. If used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>},
2447 the operand can have postincrement and postdecrement which
2448 require printing with @samp{%Pn} on IA-64.
2451 Floating-point constant 0.0 or 1.0
2454 14-bit signed integer constant
2457 22-bit signed integer constant
2460 8-bit signed integer constant for logical instructions
2463 8-bit adjusted signed integer constant for compare pseudo-ops
2466 6-bit unsigned integer constant for shift counts
2469 9-bit signed integer constant for load and store postincrements
2475 0 or @minus{}1 for @code{dep} instruction
2478 Non-volatile memory for floating-point loads and stores
2481 Integer constant in the range 1 to 4 for @code{shladd} instruction
2484 Memory operand except postincrement and postdecrement. This is
2485 now roughly the same as @samp{m} when not used together with @samp{<}
2489 @item FRV---@file{config/frv/frv.h}
2492 Register in the class @code{ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
2495 Register in the class @code{EVEN_ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
2498 Register in the class @code{CC_REGS} (@code{fcc0} to @code{fcc3} and
2499 @code{icc0} to @code{icc3}).
2502 Register in the class @code{GPR_REGS} (@code{gr0} to @code{gr63}).
2505 Register in the class @code{EVEN_REGS} (@code{gr0} to @code{gr63}).
2506 Odd registers are excluded not in the class but through the use of a machine
2507 mode larger than 4 bytes.
2510 Register in the class @code{FPR_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
2513 Register in the class @code{FEVEN_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
2514 Odd registers are excluded not in the class but through the use of a machine
2515 mode larger than 4 bytes.
2518 Register in the class @code{LR_REG} (the @code{lr} register).
2521 Register in the class @code{QUAD_REGS} (@code{gr2} to @code{gr63}).
2522 Register numbers not divisible by 4 are excluded not in the class but through
2523 the use of a machine mode larger than 8 bytes.
2526 Register in the class @code{ICC_REGS} (@code{icc0} to @code{icc3}).
2529 Register in the class @code{FCC_REGS} (@code{fcc0} to @code{fcc3}).
2532 Register in the class @code{ICR_REGS} (@code{cc4} to @code{cc7}).
2535 Register in the class @code{FCR_REGS} (@code{cc0} to @code{cc3}).
2538 Register in the class @code{QUAD_FPR_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
2539 Register numbers not divisible by 4 are excluded not in the class but through
2540 the use of a machine mode larger than 8 bytes.
2543 Register in the class @code{SPR_REGS} (@code{lcr} and @code{lr}).
2546 Register in the class @code{QUAD_ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
2549 Register in the class @code{ACCG_REGS} (@code{accg0} to @code{accg7}).
2552 Register in the class @code{CR_REGS} (@code{cc0} to @code{cc7}).
2555 Floating point constant zero
2558 6-bit signed integer constant
2561 10-bit signed integer constant
2564 16-bit signed integer constant
2567 16-bit unsigned integer constant
2570 12-bit signed integer constant that is negative---i.e.@: in the
2571 range of @minus{}2048 to @minus{}1
2577 12-bit signed integer constant that is greater than zero---i.e.@: in the
2582 @item Blackfin family---@file{config/bfin/constraints.md}
2591 A call clobbered P register.
2594 A single register. If @var{n} is in the range 0 to 7, the corresponding D
2595 register. If it is @code{A}, then the register P0.
2598 Even-numbered D register
2601 Odd-numbered D register
2604 Accumulator register.
2607 Even-numbered accumulator register.
2610 Odd-numbered accumulator register.
2622 Registers used for circular buffering, i.e. I, B, or L registers.
2637 Any D, P, B, M, I or L register.
2640 Additional registers typically used only in prologues and epilogues: RETS,
2641 RETN, RETI, RETX, RETE, ASTAT, SEQSTAT and USP.
2644 Any register except accumulators or CC.
2647 Signed 16 bit integer (in the range @minus{}32768 to 32767)
2650 Unsigned 16 bit integer (in the range 0 to 65535)
2653 Signed 7 bit integer (in the range @minus{}64 to 63)
2656 Unsigned 7 bit integer (in the range 0 to 127)
2659 Unsigned 5 bit integer (in the range 0 to 31)
2662 Signed 4 bit integer (in the range @minus{}8 to 7)
2665 Signed 3 bit integer (in the range @minus{}3 to 4)
2668 Unsigned 3 bit integer (in the range 0 to 7)
2671 Constant @var{n}, where @var{n} is a single-digit constant in the range 0 to 4.
2674 An integer equal to one of the MACFLAG_XXX constants that is suitable for
2675 use with either accumulator.
2678 An integer equal to one of the MACFLAG_XXX constants that is suitable for
2679 use only with accumulator A1.
2688 An integer constant with exactly a single bit set.
2691 An integer constant with all bits set except exactly one.
2699 @item M32C---@file{config/m32c/m32c.c}
2704 @samp{$sp}, @samp{$fb}, @samp{$sb}.
2707 Any control register, when they're 16 bits wide (nothing if control
2708 registers are 24 bits wide)
2711 Any control register, when they're 24 bits wide.
2720 $r0 or $r2, or $r2r0 for 32 bit values.
2723 $r1 or $r3, or $r3r1 for 32 bit values.
2726 A register that can hold a 64 bit value.
2729 $r0 or $r1 (registers with addressable high/low bytes)
2738 Address registers when they're 16 bits wide.
2741 Address registers when they're 24 bits wide.
2744 Registers that can hold QI values.
2747 Registers that can be used with displacements ($a0, $a1, $sb).
2750 Registers that can hold 32 bit values.
2753 Registers that can hold 16 bit values.
2756 Registers chat can hold 16 bit values, including all control
2760 $r0 through R1, plus $a0 and $a1.
2766 The memory-based pseudo-registers $mem0 through $mem15.
2769 Registers that can hold pointers (16 bit registers for r8c, m16c; 24
2770 bit registers for m32cm, m32c).
2773 Matches multiple registers in a PARALLEL to form a larger register.
2774 Used to match function return values.
2780 @minus{}128 @dots{} 127
2783 @minus{}32768 @dots{} 32767
2789 @minus{}8 @dots{} @minus{}1 or 1 @dots{} 8
2792 @minus{}16 @dots{} @minus{}1 or 1 @dots{} 16
2795 @minus{}32 @dots{} @minus{}1 or 1 @dots{} 32
2798 @minus{}65536 @dots{} @minus{}1
2801 An 8 bit value with exactly one bit set.
2804 A 16 bit value with exactly one bit set.
2807 The common src/dest memory addressing modes.
2810 Memory addressed using $a0 or $a1.
2813 Memory addressed with immediate addresses.
2816 Memory addressed using the stack pointer ($sp).
2819 Memory addressed using the frame base register ($fb).
2822 Memory addressed using the small base register ($sb).
2828 @item MeP---@file{config/mep/constraints.md}
2838 Any control register.
2841 Either the $hi or the $lo register.
2844 Coprocessor registers that can be directly loaded ($c0-$c15).
2847 Coprocessor registers that can be moved to each other.
2850 Coprocessor registers that can be moved to core registers.
2862 Registers which can be used in $tp-relative addressing.
2868 The coprocessor registers.
2871 The coprocessor control registers.
2877 User-defined register set A.
2880 User-defined register set B.
2883 User-defined register set C.
2886 User-defined register set D.
2889 Offsets for $gp-rel addressing.
2892 Constants that can be used directly with boolean insns.
2895 Constants that can be moved directly to registers.
2898 Small constants that can be added to registers.
2904 Small constants that can be compared to registers.
2907 Constants that can be loaded into the top half of registers.
2910 Signed 8-bit immediates.
2913 Symbols encoded for $tp-rel or $gp-rel addressing.
2916 Non-constant addresses for loading/saving coprocessor registers.
2919 The top half of a symbol's value.
2922 A register indirect address without offset.
2925 Symbolic references to the control bus.
2929 @item MicroBlaze---@file{config/microblaze/constraints.md}
2932 A general register (@code{r0} to @code{r31}).
2935 A status register (@code{rmsr}, @code{$fcc1} to @code{$fcc7}).
2939 @item MIPS---@file{config/mips/constraints.md}
2942 An address register. This is equivalent to @code{r} unless
2943 generating MIPS16 code.
2946 A floating-point register (if available).
2949 Formerly the @code{hi} register. This constraint is no longer supported.
2952 The @code{lo} register. Use this register to store values that are
2953 no bigger than a word.
2956 The concatenated @code{hi} and @code{lo} registers. Use this register
2957 to store doubleword values.
2960 A register suitable for use in an indirect jump. This will always be
2961 @code{$25} for @option{-mabicalls}.
2964 Register @code{$3}. Do not use this constraint in new code;
2965 it is retained only for compatibility with glibc.
2968 Equivalent to @code{r}; retained for backwards compatibility.
2971 A floating-point condition code register.
2974 A signed 16-bit constant (for arithmetic instructions).
2980 An unsigned 16-bit constant (for logic instructions).
2983 A signed 32-bit constant in which the lower 16 bits are zero.
2984 Such constants can be loaded using @code{lui}.
2987 A constant that cannot be loaded using @code{lui}, @code{addiu}
2991 A constant in the range @minus{}65535 to @minus{}1 (inclusive).
2994 A signed 15-bit constant.
2997 A constant in the range 1 to 65535 (inclusive).
3000 Floating-point zero.
3003 An address that can be used in a non-macro load or store.
3006 When compiling microMIPS code, this constraint matches a memory operand
3007 whose address is formed from a base register and a 12-bit offset. These
3008 operands can be used for microMIPS instructions such as @code{ll} and
3009 @code{sc}. When not compiling for microMIPS code, @code{ZC} is
3010 equivalent to @code{R}.
3013 When compiling microMIPS code, this constraint matches an address operand
3014 that is formed from a base register and a 12-bit offset. These operands
3015 can be used for microMIPS instructions such as @code{prefetch}. When
3016 not compiling for microMIPS code, @code{ZD} is equivalent to @code{p}.
3019 @item Motorola 680x0---@file{config/m68k/constraints.md}
3028 68881 floating-point register, if available
3031 Integer in the range 1 to 8
3034 16-bit signed number
3037 Signed number whose magnitude is greater than 0x80
3040 Integer in the range @minus{}8 to @minus{}1
3043 Signed number whose magnitude is greater than 0x100
3046 Range 24 to 31, rotatert:SI 8 to 1 expressed as rotate
3049 16 (for rotate using swap)
3052 Range 8 to 15, rotatert:HI 8 to 1 expressed as rotate
3055 Numbers that mov3q can handle
3058 Floating point constant that is not a 68881 constant
3061 Operands that satisfy 'm' when -mpcrel is in effect
3064 Operands that satisfy 's' when -mpcrel is not in effect
3067 Address register indirect addressing mode
3070 Register offset addressing
3085 Range of signed numbers that don't fit in 16 bits
3088 Integers valid for mvq
3091 Integers valid for a moveq followed by a swap
3094 Integers valid for mvz
3097 Integers valid for mvs
3103 Non-register operands allowed in clr
3107 @item Moxie---@file{config/moxie/constraints.md}
3116 A register indirect memory operand
3119 A constant in the range of 0 to 255.
3122 A constant in the range of 0 to @minus{}255.
3126 @item MSP430--@file{config/msp430/constraints.md}
3139 Integer constant -1^20..1^19.
3142 Integer constant 1-4.
3145 Memory references which do not require an extended MOVX instruction.
3148 Memory reference, labels only.
3151 Memory reference, stack only.
3155 @item NDS32---@file{config/nds32/constraints.md}
3158 LOW register class $r0 to $r7 constraint for V3/V3M ISA.
3160 LOW register class $r0 to $r7.
3162 MIDDLE register class $r0 to $r11, $r16 to $r19.
3164 HIGH register class $r12 to $r14, $r20 to $r31.
3166 Temporary assist register $ta (i.e.@: $r15).
3170 Unsigned immediate 3-bit value.
3172 Negative immediate 3-bit value in the range of @minus{}7--0.
3174 Unsigned immediate 4-bit value.
3176 Signed immediate 5-bit value.
3178 Unsigned immediate 5-bit value.
3180 Negative immediate 5-bit value in the range of @minus{}31--0.
3182 Unsigned immediate 5-bit value for movpi45 instruction with range 16--47.
3184 Unsigned immediate 6-bit value constraint for addri36.sp instruction.
3186 Unsigned immediate 8-bit value.
3188 Unsigned immediate 9-bit value.
3190 Signed immediate 10-bit value.
3192 Signed immediate 11-bit value.
3194 Signed immediate 15-bit value.
3196 Unsigned immediate 15-bit value.
3198 A constant which is not in the range of imm15u but ok for bclr instruction.
3200 A constant which is not in the range of imm15u but ok for bset instruction.
3202 A constant which is not in the range of imm15u but ok for btgl instruction.
3204 A constant whose compliment value is in the range of imm15u
3205 and ok for bitci instruction.
3207 Signed immediate 16-bit value.
3209 Signed immediate 17-bit value.
3211 Signed immediate 19-bit value.
3213 Signed immediate 20-bit value.
3215 The immediate value that can be simply set high 20-bit.
3217 The immediate value 0xff.
3219 The immediate value 0xffff.
3221 The immediate value 0x01.
3223 The immediate value 0x7ff.
3225 The immediate value with power of 2.
3227 The immediate value with power of 2 minus 1.
3229 Memory constraint for 333 format.
3231 Memory constraint for 45 format.
3233 Memory constraint for 37 format.
3236 @item Nios II family---@file{config/nios2/constraints.md}
3240 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
3241 instruction taking a signed 16-bit number. Range
3242 @minus{}32768 to 32767.
3245 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
3246 instruction taking an unsigned 16-bit number. Range
3250 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
3251 instruction taking only the upper 16-bits of a
3252 32-bit number. Range 32-bit numbers with the lower
3256 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand for a
3257 shift instruction. Range 0 to 31.
3260 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand for
3261 only the value 0. Can be used in conjunction with
3262 the format modifier @code{z} to use @code{r0}
3263 instead of @code{0} in the assembly output.
3266 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand for
3267 a custom instruction opcode. Range 0 to 255.
3270 Matches immediates which are addresses in the small
3271 data section and therefore can be added to @code{gp}
3272 as a 16-bit immediate to re-create their 32-bit value.
3276 A @code{const} wrapped @code{UNSPEC} expression,
3277 representing a supported PIC or TLS relocation.
3282 @item PDP-11---@file{config/pdp11/constraints.md}
3285 Floating point registers AC0 through AC3. These can be loaded from/to
3286 memory with a single instruction.
3289 Odd numbered general registers (R1, R3, R5). These are used for
3290 16-bit multiply operations.
3293 Any of the floating point registers (AC0 through AC5).
3296 Floating point constant 0.
3299 An integer constant that fits in 16 bits.
3302 An integer constant whose low order 16 bits are zero.
3305 An integer constant that does not meet the constraints for codes
3306 @samp{I} or @samp{J}.
3309 The integer constant 1.
3312 The integer constant @minus{}1.
3315 The integer constant 0.
3318 Integer constants @minus{}4 through @minus{}1 and 1 through 4; shifts by these
3319 amounts are handled as multiple single-bit shifts rather than a single
3320 variable-length shift.
3323 A memory reference which requires an additional word (address or
3324 offset) after the opcode.
3327 A memory reference that is encoded within the opcode.
3331 @item RL78---@file{config/rl78/constraints.md}
3335 An integer constant in the range 1 @dots{} 7.
3337 An integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 255.
3339 An integer constant in the range @minus{}255 @dots{} 0
3341 The integer constant 1.
3343 The integer constant -1.
3345 The integer constant 0.
3347 The integer constant 2.
3349 The integer constant -2.
3351 An integer constant in the range 1 @dots{} 15.
3353 The built-in compare types--eq, ne, gtu, ltu, geu, and leu.
3355 The synthetic compare types--gt, lt, ge, and le.
3357 A memory reference with an absolute address.
3359 A memory reference using @code{BC} as a base register, with an optional offset.
3361 A memory reference using @code{AX}, @code{BC}, @code{DE}, or @code{HL} for the address, for calls.
3363 A memory reference using any 16-bit register pair for the address, for calls.
3365 A memory reference using @code{DE} as a base register, with an optional offset.
3367 A memory reference using @code{DE} as a base register, without any offset.
3369 Any memory reference to an address in the far address space.
3371 A memory reference using @code{HL} as a base register, with an optional one-byte offset.
3373 A memory reference using @code{HL} as a base register, with @code{B} or @code{C} as the index register.
3375 A memory reference using @code{HL} as a base register, without any offset.
3377 A memory reference using @code{SP} as a base register, with an optional one-byte offset.
3379 Any memory reference to an address in the near address space.
3381 The @code{AX} register.
3383 The @code{BC} register.
3385 The @code{DE} register.
3387 @code{A} through @code{L} registers.
3389 The @code{SP} register.
3391 The @code{HL} register.
3393 The 16-bit @code{R8} register.
3395 The 16-bit @code{R10} register.
3397 The registers reserved for interrupts (@code{R24} to @code{R31}).
3399 The @code{A} register.
3401 The @code{B} register.
3403 The @code{C} register.
3405 The @code{D} register.
3407 The @code{E} register.
3409 The @code{H} register.
3411 The @code{L} register.
3413 The virtual registers.
3415 The @code{PSW} register.
3417 The @code{X} register.
3421 @item RX---@file{config/rx/constraints.md}
3424 An address which does not involve register indirect addressing or
3425 pre/post increment/decrement addressing.
3431 A constant in the range @minus{}256 to 255, inclusive.
3434 A constant in the range @minus{}128 to 127, inclusive.
3437 A constant in the range @minus{}32768 to 32767, inclusive.
3440 A constant in the range @minus{}8388608 to 8388607, inclusive.
3443 A constant in the range 0 to 15, inclusive.
3448 @item SPARC---@file{config/sparc/sparc.h}
3451 Floating-point register on the SPARC-V8 architecture and
3452 lower floating-point register on the SPARC-V9 architecture.
3455 Floating-point register. It is equivalent to @samp{f} on the
3456 SPARC-V8 architecture and contains both lower and upper
3457 floating-point registers on the SPARC-V9 architecture.
3460 Floating-point condition code register.
3463 Lower floating-point register. It is only valid on the SPARC-V9
3464 architecture when the Visual Instruction Set is available.
3467 Floating-point register. It is only valid on the SPARC-V9 architecture
3468 when the Visual Instruction Set is available.
3471 64-bit global or out register for the SPARC-V8+ architecture.
3474 The constant all-ones, for floating-point.
3477 Signed 5-bit constant
3483 Signed 13-bit constant
3489 32-bit constant with the low 12 bits clear (a constant that can be
3490 loaded with the @code{sethi} instruction)
3493 A constant in the range supported by @code{movcc} instructions (11-bit
3497 A constant in the range supported by @code{movrcc} instructions (10-bit
3501 Same as @samp{K}, except that it verifies that bits that are not in the
3502 lower 32-bit range are all zero. Must be used instead of @samp{K} for
3503 modes wider than @code{SImode}
3512 Signed 13-bit constant, sign-extended to 32 or 64 bits
3518 Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
3519 be moved into an integer register using a single sethi
3523 Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
3524 be moved into an integer register using a single mov
3528 Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
3529 be moved into an integer register using a high/lo_sum
3530 instruction sequence
3533 Memory address aligned to an 8-byte boundary
3539 Memory address for @samp{e} constraint registers
3542 Memory address with only a base register
3549 @item SPU---@file{config/spu/spu.h}
3552 An immediate which can be loaded with the il/ila/ilh/ilhu instructions. const_int is treated as a 64 bit value.
3555 An immediate for and/xor/or instructions. const_int is treated as a 64 bit value.
3558 An immediate for the @code{iohl} instruction. const_int is treated as a 64 bit value.
3561 An immediate which can be loaded with @code{fsmbi}.
3564 An immediate which can be loaded with the il/ila/ilh/ilhu instructions. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
3567 An immediate for most arithmetic instructions. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
3570 An immediate for and/xor/or instructions. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
3573 An immediate for the @code{iohl} instruction. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
3576 A constant in the range [@minus{}64, 63] for shift/rotate instructions.
3579 An unsigned 7-bit constant for conversion/nop/channel instructions.
3582 A signed 10-bit constant for most arithmetic instructions.
3585 A signed 16 bit immediate for @code{stop}.
3588 An unsigned 16-bit constant for @code{iohl} and @code{fsmbi}.
3591 An unsigned 7-bit constant whose 3 least significant bits are 0.
3594 An unsigned 3-bit constant for 16-byte rotates and shifts
3597 Call operand, reg, for indirect calls
3600 Call operand, symbol, for relative calls.
3603 Call operand, const_int, for absolute calls.
3606 An immediate which can be loaded with the il/ila/ilh/ilhu instructions. const_int is sign extended to 128 bit.
3609 An immediate for shift and rotate instructions. const_int is treated as a 32 bit value.
3612 An immediate for and/xor/or instructions. const_int is sign extended as a 128 bit.
3615 An immediate for the @code{iohl} instruction. const_int is sign extended to 128 bit.
3619 @item S/390 and zSeries---@file{config/s390/s390.h}
3622 Address register (general purpose register except r0)
3625 Condition code register
3628 Data register (arbitrary general purpose register)
3631 Floating-point register
3634 Unsigned 8-bit constant (0--255)
3637 Unsigned 12-bit constant (0--4095)
3640 Signed 16-bit constant (@minus{}32768--32767)
3643 Value appropriate as displacement.
3646 for short displacement
3647 @item (@minus{}524288..524287)
3648 for long displacement
3652 Constant integer with a value of 0x7fffffff.
3655 Multiple letter constraint followed by 4 parameter letters.
3658 number of the part counting from most to least significant
3662 mode of the containing operand
3664 value of the other parts (F---all bits set)
3666 The constraint matches if the specified part of a constant
3667 has a value different from its other parts.
3670 Memory reference without index register and with short displacement.
3673 Memory reference with index register and short displacement.
3676 Memory reference without index register but with long displacement.
3679 Memory reference with index register and long displacement.
3682 Pointer with short displacement.
3685 Pointer with long displacement.
3688 Shift count operand.
3692 @item Score family---@file{config/score/score.h}
3695 Registers from r0 to r32.
3698 Registers from r0 to r16.
3701 r8---r11 or r22---r27 registers.
3722 cnt + lcb + scb register.
3725 cr0---cr15 register.
3737 cp1 + cp2 + cp3 registers.
3740 High 16-bit constant (32-bit constant with 16 LSBs zero).
3743 Unsigned 5 bit integer (in the range 0 to 31).
3746 Unsigned 16 bit integer (in the range 0 to 65535).
3749 Signed 16 bit integer (in the range @minus{}32768 to 32767).
3752 Unsigned 14 bit integer (in the range 0 to 16383).
3755 Signed 14 bit integer (in the range @minus{}8192 to 8191).
3761 @item Xstormy16---@file{config/stormy16/stormy16.h}
3776 Registers r0 through r7.
3779 Registers r0 and r1.
3785 Registers r8 and r9.
3788 A constant between 0 and 3 inclusive.
3791 A constant that has exactly one bit set.
3794 A constant that has exactly one bit clear.
3797 A constant between 0 and 255 inclusive.
3800 A constant between @minus{}255 and 0 inclusive.
3803 A constant between @minus{}3 and 0 inclusive.
3806 A constant between 1 and 4 inclusive.
3809 A constant between @minus{}4 and @minus{}1 inclusive.
3812 A memory reference that is a stack push.
3815 A memory reference that is a stack pop.
3818 A memory reference that refers to a constant address of known value.
3821 The register indicated by Rx (not implemented yet).
3824 A constant that is not between 2 and 15 inclusive.
3831 @item TI C6X family---@file{config/c6x/constraints.md}
3834 Register file A (A0--A31).
3837 Register file B (B0--B31).
3840 Predicate registers in register file A (A0--A2 on C64X and
3841 higher, A1 and A2 otherwise).
3844 Predicate registers in register file B (B0--B2).
3847 A call-used register in register file B (B0--B9, B16--B31).
3850 Register file A, excluding predicate registers (A3--A31,
3851 plus A0 if not C64X or higher).
3854 Register file B, excluding predicate registers (B3--B31).
3857 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 15.
3860 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 31.
3863 Integer constant in the range @minus{}31 @dots{} 0.
3866 Integer constant in the range @minus{}16 @dots{} 15.
3869 Integer constant that can be the operand of an ADDA or a SUBA insn.
3872 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 65535.
3875 Integer constant in the range @minus{}32768 @dots{} 32767.
3878 Integer constant in the range @math{-2^{20}} @dots{} @math{2^{20} - 1}.
3881 Integer constant that is a valid mask for the clr instruction.
3884 Integer constant that is a valid mask for the set instruction.
3887 Memory location with A base register.
3890 Memory location with B base register.
3894 On C64x+ targets, a GP-relative small data reference.
3897 Any kind of @code{SYMBOL_REF}, for use in a call address.
3900 Any kind of immediate operand, unless it matches the S0 constraint.
3903 Memory location with B base register, but not using a long offset.
3906 A memory operand with an address that can't be used in an unaligned access.
3910 Register B14 (aka DP).
3914 @item TILE-Gx---@file{config/tilegx/constraints.md}
3927 Each of these represents a register constraint for an individual
3928 register, from r0 to r10.
3931 Signed 8-bit integer constant.
3934 Signed 16-bit integer constant.
3937 Unsigned 16-bit integer constant.
3940 Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented by one
3941 (@minus{}129 @dots{} 126).
3944 Memory operand. If used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}, the
3945 operand can have postincrement which requires printing with @samp{%In}
3946 and @samp{%in} on TILE-Gx. For example:
3949 asm ("st_add %I0,%1,%i0" : "=m<>" (*mem) : "r" (val));
3953 A bit mask suitable for the BFINS instruction.
3956 Integer constant that is a byte tiled out eight times.
3959 The integer zero constant.
3962 Integer constant that is a sign-extended byte tiled out as four shorts.
3965 Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented
3966 (@minus{}129 @dots{} 126), but excluding -1.
3969 Integer constant that has all 1 bits consecutive and starting at bit 0.
3972 A 16-bit fragment of a got, tls, or pc-relative reference.
3975 Memory operand except postincrement. This is roughly the same as
3976 @samp{m} when not used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}.
3979 An 8-element vector constant with identical elements.
3982 A 4-element vector constant with identical elements.
3985 The integer constant 0xffffffff.
3988 The integer constant 0xffffffff00000000.
3992 @item TILEPro---@file{config/tilepro/constraints.md}
4005 Each of these represents a register constraint for an individual
4006 register, from r0 to r10.
4009 Signed 8-bit integer constant.
4012 Signed 16-bit integer constant.
4015 Nonzero integer constant with low 16 bits zero.
4018 Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented by one
4019 (@minus{}129 @dots{} 126).
4022 Memory operand. If used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}, the
4023 operand can have postincrement which requires printing with @samp{%In}
4024 and @samp{%in} on TILEPro. For example:
4027 asm ("swadd %I0,%1,%i0" : "=m<>" (mem) : "r" (val));
4031 A bit mask suitable for the MM instruction.
4034 Integer constant that is a byte tiled out four times.
4037 The integer zero constant.
4040 Integer constant that is a sign-extended byte tiled out as two shorts.
4043 Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented
4044 (@minus{}129 @dots{} 126), but excluding -1.
4047 A symbolic operand, or a 16-bit fragment of a got, tls, or pc-relative
4051 Memory operand except postincrement. This is roughly the same as
4052 @samp{m} when not used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}.
4055 A 4-element vector constant with identical elements.
4058 A 2-element vector constant with identical elements.
4062 @item Xtensa---@file{config/xtensa/constraints.md}
4065 General-purpose 32-bit register
4068 One-bit boolean register
4071 MAC16 40-bit accumulator register
4074 Signed 12-bit integer constant, for use in MOVI instructions
4077 Signed 8-bit integer constant, for use in ADDI instructions
4080 Integer constant valid for BccI instructions
4083 Unsigned constant valid for BccUI instructions
4090 @node Disable Insn Alternatives
4091 @subsection Disable insn alternatives using the @code{enabled} attribute
4094 The @code{enabled} insn attribute may be used to disable certain insn
4095 alternatives for machine-specific reasons. This is useful when adding
4096 new instructions to an existing pattern which are only available for
4097 certain cpu architecture levels as specified with the @code{-march=}
4100 If an insn alternative is disabled, then it will never be used. The
4101 compiler treats the constraints for the disabled alternative as
4104 In order to make use of the @code{enabled} attribute a back end has to add
4105 in the machine description files:
4109 A definition of the @code{enabled} insn attribute. The attribute is
4110 defined as usual using the @code{define_attr} command. This
4111 definition should be based on other insn attributes and/or target flags.
4112 The @code{enabled} attribute is a numeric attribute and should evaluate to
4113 @code{(const_int 1)} for an enabled alternative and to
4114 @code{(const_int 0)} otherwise.
4116 A definition of another insn attribute used to describe for what
4117 reason an insn alternative might be available or
4118 not. E.g. @code{cpu_facility} as in the example below.
4120 An assignment for the second attribute to each insn definition
4121 combining instructions which are not all available under the same
4122 circumstances. (Note: It obviously only makes sense for definitions
4123 with more than one alternative. Otherwise the insn pattern should be
4124 disabled or enabled using the insn condition.)
4127 E.g. the following two patterns could easily be merged using the @code{enabled}
4132 (define_insn "*movdi_old"
4133 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
4134 (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" " d"))]
4138 (define_insn "*movdi_new"
4139 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d,f,d")
4140 (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" " d,d,f"))]
4153 (define_insn "*movdi_combined"
4154 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d,f,d")
4155 (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" " d,d,f"))]
4161 [(set_attr "cpu_facility" "*,new,new")])
4165 with the @code{enabled} attribute defined like this:
4169 (define_attr "cpu_facility" "standard,new" (const_string "standard"))
4171 (define_attr "enabled" ""
4172 (cond [(eq_attr "cpu_facility" "standard") (const_int 1)
4173 (and (eq_attr "cpu_facility" "new")
4174 (ne (symbol_ref "TARGET_NEW") (const_int 0)))
4183 @node Define Constraints
4184 @subsection Defining Machine-Specific Constraints
4185 @cindex defining constraints
4186 @cindex constraints, defining
4188 Machine-specific constraints fall into two categories: register and
4189 non-register constraints. Within the latter category, constraints
4190 which allow subsets of all possible memory or address operands should
4191 be specially marked, to give @code{reload} more information.
4193 Machine-specific constraints can be given names of arbitrary length,
4194 but they must be entirely composed of letters, digits, underscores
4195 (@samp{_}), and angle brackets (@samp{< >}). Like C identifiers, they
4196 must begin with a letter or underscore.
4198 In order to avoid ambiguity in operand constraint strings, no
4199 constraint can have a name that begins with any other constraint's
4200 name. For example, if @code{x} is defined as a constraint name,
4201 @code{xy} may not be, and vice versa. As a consequence of this rule,
4202 no constraint may begin with one of the generic constraint letters:
4203 @samp{E F V X g i m n o p r s}.
4205 Register constraints correspond directly to register classes.
4206 @xref{Register Classes}. There is thus not much flexibility in their
4209 @deffn {MD Expression} define_register_constraint name regclass docstring
4210 All three arguments are string constants.
4211 @var{name} is the name of the constraint, as it will appear in
4212 @code{match_operand} expressions. If @var{name} is a multi-letter
4213 constraint its length shall be the same for all constraints starting
4214 with the same letter. @var{regclass} can be either the
4215 name of the corresponding register class (@pxref{Register Classes}),
4216 or a C expression which evaluates to the appropriate register class.
4217 If it is an expression, it must have no side effects, and it cannot
4218 look at the operand. The usual use of expressions is to map some
4219 register constraints to @code{NO_REGS} when the register class
4220 is not available on a given subarchitecture.
4222 @var{docstring} is a sentence documenting the meaning of the
4223 constraint. Docstrings are explained further below.
4226 Non-register constraints are more like predicates: the constraint
4227 definition gives a Boolean expression which indicates whether the
4230 @deffn {MD Expression} define_constraint name docstring exp
4231 The @var{name} and @var{docstring} arguments are the same as for
4232 @code{define_register_constraint}, but note that the docstring comes
4233 immediately after the name for these expressions. @var{exp} is an RTL
4234 expression, obeying the same rules as the RTL expressions in predicate
4235 definitions. @xref{Defining Predicates}, for details. If it
4236 evaluates true, the constraint matches; if it evaluates false, it
4237 doesn't. Constraint expressions should indicate which RTL codes they
4238 might match, just like predicate expressions.
4240 @code{match_test} C expressions have access to the
4241 following variables:
4245 The RTL object defining the operand.
4247 The machine mode of @var{op}.
4249 @samp{INTVAL (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is a @code{const_int}.
4251 @samp{CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is an integer
4252 @code{const_double}.
4254 @samp{CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is an integer
4255 @code{const_double}.
4257 @samp{CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is a floating-point
4258 @code{const_double}.
4261 The @var{*val} variables should only be used once another piece of the
4262 expression has verified that @var{op} is the appropriate kind of RTL
4266 Most non-register constraints should be defined with
4267 @code{define_constraint}. The remaining two definition expressions
4268 are only appropriate for constraints that should be handled specially
4269 by @code{reload} if they fail to match.
4271 @deffn {MD Expression} define_memory_constraint name docstring exp
4272 Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all memory
4273 operands: that is, @code{reload} can make them match by converting the
4274 operand to the form @samp{@w{(mem (reg @var{X}))}}, where @var{X} is a
4275 base register (from the register class specified by
4276 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}, @pxref{Register Classes}).
4278 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
4279 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
4280 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined to represent a
4281 memory address of this type. If @samp{Q} is defined with
4282 @code{define_memory_constraint}, a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any
4283 memory operand, because @code{reload} knows it can simply copy the
4284 memory address into a base register if required. This is analogous to
4285 the way an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
4287 The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
4288 @code{define_constraint}.
4291 @deffn {MD Expression} define_address_constraint name docstring exp
4292 Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all address
4293 operands: that is, @code{reload} can make the constraint match by
4294 converting the operand to the form @samp{@w{(reg @var{X})}}, again
4295 with @var{X} a base register.
4297 Constraints defined with @code{define_address_constraint} can only be
4298 used with the @code{address_operand} predicate, or machine-specific
4299 predicates that work the same way. They are treated analogously to
4300 the generic @samp{p} constraint.
4302 The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
4303 @code{define_constraint}.
4306 For historical reasons, names beginning with the letters @samp{G H}
4307 are reserved for constraints that match only @code{const_double}s, and
4308 names beginning with the letters @samp{I J K L M N O P} are reserved
4309 for constraints that match only @code{const_int}s. This may change in
4310 the future. For the time being, constraints with these names must be
4311 written in a stylized form, so that @code{genpreds} can tell you did
4316 (define_constraint "[@var{GHIJKLMNOP}]@dots{}"
4318 (and (match_code "const_int") ; @r{@code{const_double} for G/H}
4319 @var{condition}@dots{})) ; @r{usually a @code{match_test}}
4322 @c the semicolons line up in the formatted manual
4324 It is fine to use names beginning with other letters for constraints
4325 that match @code{const_double}s or @code{const_int}s.
4327 Each docstring in a constraint definition should be one or more complete
4328 sentences, marked up in Texinfo format. @emph{They are currently unused.}
4329 In the future they will be copied into the GCC manual, in @ref{Machine
4330 Constraints}, replacing the hand-maintained tables currently found in
4331 that section. Also, in the future the compiler may use this to give
4332 more helpful diagnostics when poor choice of @code{asm} constraints
4333 causes a reload failure.
4335 If you put the pseudo-Texinfo directive @samp{@@internal} at the
4336 beginning of a docstring, then (in the future) it will appear only in
4337 the internals manual's version of the machine-specific constraint tables.
4338 Use this for constraints that should not appear in @code{asm} statements.
4340 @node C Constraint Interface
4341 @subsection Testing constraints from C
4342 @cindex testing constraints
4343 @cindex constraints, testing
4345 It is occasionally useful to test a constraint from C code rather than
4346 implicitly via the constraint string in a @code{match_operand}. The
4347 generated file @file{tm_p.h} declares a few interfaces for working
4348 with machine-specific constraints. None of these interfaces work with
4349 the generic constraints described in @ref{Simple Constraints}. This
4350 may change in the future.
4352 @strong{Warning:} @file{tm_p.h} may declare other functions that
4353 operate on constraints, besides the ones documented here. Do not use
4354 those functions from machine-dependent code. They exist to implement
4355 the old constraint interface that machine-independent components of
4356 the compiler still expect. They will change or disappear in the
4359 Some valid constraint names are not valid C identifiers, so there is a
4360 mangling scheme for referring to them from C@. Constraint names that
4361 do not contain angle brackets or underscores are left unchanged.
4362 Underscores are doubled, each @samp{<} is replaced with @samp{_l}, and
4363 each @samp{>} with @samp{_g}. Here are some examples:
4365 @c the @c's prevent double blank lines in the printed manual.
4367 @multitable {Original} {Mangled}
4368 @item @strong{Original} @tab @strong{Mangled} @c
4369 @item @code{x} @tab @code{x} @c
4370 @item @code{P42x} @tab @code{P42x} @c
4371 @item @code{P4_x} @tab @code{P4__x} @c
4372 @item @code{P4>x} @tab @code{P4_gx} @c
4373 @item @code{P4>>} @tab @code{P4_g_g} @c
4374 @item @code{P4_g>} @tab @code{P4__g_g} @c
4378 Throughout this section, the variable @var{c} is either a constraint
4379 in the abstract sense, or a constant from @code{enum constraint_num};
4380 the variable @var{m} is a mangled constraint name (usually as part of
4381 a larger identifier).
4383 @deftp Enum constraint_num
4384 For each machine-specific constraint, there is a corresponding
4385 enumeration constant: @samp{CONSTRAINT_} plus the mangled name of the
4386 constraint. Functions that take an @code{enum constraint_num} as an
4387 argument expect one of these constants.
4389 Machine-independent constraints do not have associated constants.
4390 This may change in the future.
4393 @deftypefun {inline bool} satisfies_constraint_@var{m} (rtx @var{exp})
4394 For each machine-specific, non-register constraint @var{m}, there is
4395 one of these functions; it returns @code{true} if @var{exp} satisfies the
4396 constraint. These functions are only visible if @file{rtl.h} was included
4397 before @file{tm_p.h}.
4400 @deftypefun bool constraint_satisfied_p (rtx @var{exp}, enum constraint_num @var{c})
4401 Like the @code{satisfies_constraint_@var{m}} functions, but the
4402 constraint to test is given as an argument, @var{c}. If @var{c}
4403 specifies a register constraint, this function will always return
4407 @deftypefun {enum reg_class} regclass_for_constraint (enum constraint_num @var{c})
4408 Returns the register class associated with @var{c}. If @var{c} is not
4409 a register constraint, or those registers are not available for the
4410 currently selected subtarget, returns @code{NO_REGS}.
4413 Here is an example use of @code{satisfies_constraint_@var{m}}. In
4414 peephole optimizations (@pxref{Peephole Definitions}), operand
4415 constraint strings are ignored, so if there are relevant constraints,
4416 they must be tested in the C condition. In the example, the
4417 optimization is applied if operand 2 does @emph{not} satisfy the
4418 @samp{K} constraint. (This is a simplified version of a peephole
4419 definition from the i386 machine description.)
4423 [(match_scratch:SI 3 "r")
4424 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
4425 (mult:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "memory_operand" "")
4426 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "")))]
4428 "!satisfies_constraint_K (operands[2])"
4430 [(set (match_dup 3) (match_dup 1))
4431 (set (match_dup 0) (mult:SI (match_dup 3) (match_dup 2)))]
4436 @node Standard Names
4437 @section Standard Pattern Names For Generation
4438 @cindex standard pattern names
4439 @cindex pattern names
4440 @cindex names, pattern
4442 Here is a table of the instruction names that are meaningful in the RTL
4443 generation pass of the compiler. Giving one of these names to an
4444 instruction pattern tells the RTL generation pass that it can use the
4445 pattern to accomplish a certain task.
4448 @cindex @code{mov@var{m}} instruction pattern
4449 @item @samp{mov@var{m}}
4450 Here @var{m} stands for a two-letter machine mode name, in lowercase.
4451 This instruction pattern moves data with that machine mode from operand
4452 1 to operand 0. For example, @samp{movsi} moves full-word data.
4454 If operand 0 is a @code{subreg} with mode @var{m} of a register whose
4455 own mode is wider than @var{m}, the effect of this instruction is
4456 to store the specified value in the part of the register that corresponds
4457 to mode @var{m}. Bits outside of @var{m}, but which are within the
4458 same target word as the @code{subreg} are undefined. Bits which are
4459 outside the target word are left unchanged.
4461 This class of patterns is special in several ways. First of all, each
4462 of these names up to and including full word size @emph{must} be defined,
4463 because there is no other way to copy a datum from one place to another.
4464 If there are patterns accepting operands in larger modes,
4465 @samp{mov@var{m}} must be defined for integer modes of those sizes.
4467 Second, these patterns are not used solely in the RTL generation pass.
4468 Even the reload pass can generate move insns to copy values from stack
4469 slots into temporary registers. When it does so, one of the operands is
4470 a hard register and the other is an operand that can need to be reloaded
4474 Therefore, when given such a pair of operands, the pattern must generate
4475 RTL which needs no reloading and needs no temporary registers---no
4476 registers other than the operands. For example, if you support the
4477 pattern with a @code{define_expand}, then in such a case the
4478 @code{define_expand} mustn't call @code{force_reg} or any other such
4479 function which might generate new pseudo registers.
4481 This requirement exists even for subword modes on a RISC machine where
4482 fetching those modes from memory normally requires several insns and
4483 some temporary registers.
4485 @findex change_address
4486 During reload a memory reference with an invalid address may be passed
4487 as an operand. Such an address will be replaced with a valid address
4488 later in the reload pass. In this case, nothing may be done with the
4489 address except to use it as it stands. If it is copied, it will not be
4490 replaced with a valid address. No attempt should be made to make such
4491 an address into a valid address and no routine (such as
4492 @code{change_address}) that will do so may be called. Note that
4493 @code{general_operand} will fail when applied to such an address.
4495 @findex reload_in_progress
4496 The global variable @code{reload_in_progress} (which must be explicitly
4497 declared if required) can be used to determine whether such special
4498 handling is required.
4500 The variety of operands that have reloads depends on the rest of the
4501 machine description, but typically on a RISC machine these can only be
4502 pseudo registers that did not get hard registers, while on other
4503 machines explicit memory references will get optional reloads.
4505 If a scratch register is required to move an object to or from memory,
4506 it can be allocated using @code{gen_reg_rtx} prior to life analysis.
4508 If there are cases which need scratch registers during or after reload,
4509 you must provide an appropriate secondary_reload target hook.
4511 @findex can_create_pseudo_p
4512 The macro @code{can_create_pseudo_p} can be used to determine if it
4513 is unsafe to create new pseudo registers. If this variable is nonzero, then
4514 it is unsafe to call @code{gen_reg_rtx} to allocate a new pseudo.
4516 The constraints on a @samp{mov@var{m}} must permit moving any hard
4517 register to any other hard register provided that
4518 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} permits mode @var{m} in both registers and
4519 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their classes returns a value
4522 It is obligatory to support floating point @samp{mov@var{m}}
4523 instructions into and out of any registers that can hold fixed point
4524 values, because unions and structures (which have modes @code{SImode} or
4525 @code{DImode}) can be in those registers and they may have floating
4528 There may also be a need to support fixed point @samp{mov@var{m}}
4529 instructions in and out of floating point registers. Unfortunately, I
4530 have forgotten why this was so, and I don't know whether it is still
4531 true. If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} rejects fixed point values in
4532 floating point registers, then the constraints of the fixed point
4533 @samp{mov@var{m}} instructions must be designed to avoid ever trying to
4534 reload into a floating point register.
4536 @cindex @code{reload_in} instruction pattern
4537 @cindex @code{reload_out} instruction pattern
4538 @item @samp{reload_in@var{m}}
4539 @itemx @samp{reload_out@var{m}}
4540 These named patterns have been obsoleted by the target hook
4541 @code{secondary_reload}.
4543 Like @samp{mov@var{m}}, but used when a scratch register is required to
4544 move between operand 0 and operand 1. Operand 2 describes the scratch
4545 register. See the discussion of the @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS}
4546 macro in @pxref{Register Classes}.
4548 There are special restrictions on the form of the @code{match_operand}s
4549 used in these patterns. First, only the predicate for the reload
4550 operand is examined, i.e., @code{reload_in} examines operand 1, but not
4551 the predicates for operand 0 or 2. Second, there may be only one
4552 alternative in the constraints. Third, only a single register class
4553 letter may be used for the constraint; subsequent constraint letters
4554 are ignored. As a special exception, an empty constraint string
4555 matches the @code{ALL_REGS} register class. This may relieve ports
4556 of the burden of defining an @code{ALL_REGS} constraint letter just
4559 @cindex @code{movstrict@var{m}} instruction pattern
4560 @item @samp{movstrict@var{m}}
4561 Like @samp{mov@var{m}} except that if operand 0 is a @code{subreg}
4562 with mode @var{m} of a register whose natural mode is wider,
4563 the @samp{movstrict@var{m}} instruction is guaranteed not to alter
4564 any of the register except the part which belongs to mode @var{m}.
4566 @cindex @code{movmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
4567 @item @samp{movmisalign@var{m}}
4568 This variant of a move pattern is designed to load or store a value
4569 from a memory address that is not naturally aligned for its mode.
4570 For a store, the memory will be in operand 0; for a load, the memory
4571 will be in operand 1. The other operand is guaranteed not to be a
4572 memory, so that it's easy to tell whether this is a load or store.
4574 This pattern is used by the autovectorizer, and when expanding a
4575 @code{MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF} expression.
4577 @cindex @code{load_multiple} instruction pattern
4578 @item @samp{load_multiple}
4579 Load several consecutive memory locations into consecutive registers.
4580 Operand 0 is the first of the consecutive registers, operand 1
4581 is the first memory location, and operand 2 is a constant: the
4582 number of consecutive registers.
4584 Define this only if the target machine really has such an instruction;
4585 do not define this if the most efficient way of loading consecutive
4586 registers from memory is to do them one at a time.
4588 On some machines, there are restrictions as to which consecutive
4589 registers can be stored into memory, such as particular starting or
4590 ending register numbers or only a range of valid counts. For those
4591 machines, use a @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions})
4592 and make the pattern fail if the restrictions are not met.
4594 Write the generated insn as a @code{parallel} with elements being a
4595 @code{set} of one register from the appropriate memory location (you may
4596 also need @code{use} or @code{clobber} elements). Use a
4597 @code{match_parallel} (@pxref{RTL Template}) to recognize the insn. See
4598 @file{rs6000.md} for examples of the use of this insn pattern.
4600 @cindex @samp{store_multiple} instruction pattern
4601 @item @samp{store_multiple}
4602 Similar to @samp{load_multiple}, but store several consecutive registers
4603 into consecutive memory locations. Operand 0 is the first of the
4604 consecutive memory locations, operand 1 is the first register, and
4605 operand 2 is a constant: the number of consecutive registers.
4607 @cindex @code{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4608 @item @samp{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4609 Perform an interleaved load of several vectors from memory operand 1
4610 into register operand 0. Both operands have mode @var{m}. The register
4611 operand is viewed as holding consecutive vectors of mode @var{n},
4612 while the memory operand is a flat array that contains the same number
4613 of elements. The operation is equivalent to:
4616 int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4617 for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4618 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4619 operand0[i][j] = operand1[j * c + i];
4622 For example, @samp{vec_load_lanestiv4hi} loads 8 16-bit values
4623 from memory into a register of mode @samp{TI}@. The register
4624 contains two consecutive vectors of mode @samp{V4HI}@.
4626 This pattern can only be used if:
4628 TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (@var{n}, @var{c})
4630 is true. GCC assumes that, if a target supports this kind of
4631 instruction for some mode @var{n}, it also supports unaligned
4632 loads for vectors of mode @var{n}.
4634 @cindex @code{vec_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4635 @item @samp{vec_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4636 Equivalent to @samp{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}, with the memory
4637 and register operands reversed. That is, the instruction is
4641 int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4642 for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4643 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4644 operand0[j * c + i] = operand1[i][j];
4647 for a memory operand 0 and register operand 1.
4649 @cindex @code{vec_set@var{m}} instruction pattern
4650 @item @samp{vec_set@var{m}}
4651 Set given field in the vector value. Operand 0 is the vector to modify,
4652 operand 1 is new value of field and operand 2 specify the field index.
4654 @cindex @code{vec_extract@var{m}} instruction pattern
4655 @item @samp{vec_extract@var{m}}
4656 Extract given field from the vector value. Operand 1 is the vector, operand 2
4657 specify field index and operand 0 place to store value into.
4659 @cindex @code{vec_init@var{m}} instruction pattern
4660 @item @samp{vec_init@var{m}}
4661 Initialize the vector to given values. Operand 0 is the vector to initialize
4662 and operand 1 is parallel containing values for individual fields.
4664 @cindex @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4665 @item @samp{vcond@var{m}@var{n}}
4666 Output a conditional vector move. Operand 0 is the destination to
4667 receive a combination of operand 1 and operand 2, which are of mode @var{m},
4668 dependent on the outcome of the predicate in operand 3 which is a
4669 vector comparison with operands of mode @var{n} in operands 4 and 5. The
4670 modes @var{m} and @var{n} should have the same size. Operand 0
4671 will be set to the value @var{op1} & @var{msk} | @var{op2} & ~@var{msk}
4672 where @var{msk} is computed by element-wise evaluation of the vector
4673 comparison with a truth value of all-ones and a false value of all-zeros.
4675 @cindex @code{vec_perm@var{m}} instruction pattern
4676 @item @samp{vec_perm@var{m}}
4677 Output a (variable) vector permutation. Operand 0 is the destination
4678 to receive elements from operand 1 and operand 2, which are of mode
4679 @var{m}. Operand 3 is the @dfn{selector}. It is an integral mode
4680 vector of the same width and number of elements as mode @var{m}.
4682 The input elements are numbered from 0 in operand 1 through
4683 @math{2*@var{N}-1} in operand 2. The elements of the selector must
4684 be computed modulo @math{2*@var{N}}. Note that if
4685 @code{rtx_equal_p(operand1, operand2)}, this can be implemented
4686 with just operand 1 and selector elements modulo @var{N}.
4688 In order to make things easy for a number of targets, if there is no
4689 @samp{vec_perm} pattern for mode @var{m}, but there is for mode @var{q}
4690 where @var{q} is a vector of @code{QImode} of the same width as @var{m},
4691 the middle-end will lower the mode @var{m} @code{VEC_PERM_EXPR} to
4694 @cindex @code{vec_perm_const@var{m}} instruction pattern
4695 @item @samp{vec_perm_const@var{m}}
4696 Like @samp{vec_perm} except that the permutation is a compile-time
4697 constant. That is, operand 3, the @dfn{selector}, is a @code{CONST_VECTOR}.
4699 Some targets cannot perform a permutation with a variable selector,
4700 but can efficiently perform a constant permutation. Further, the
4701 target hook @code{vec_perm_ok} is queried to determine if the
4702 specific constant permutation is available efficiently; the named
4703 pattern is never expanded without @code{vec_perm_ok} returning true.
4705 There is no need for a target to supply both @samp{vec_perm@var{m}}
4706 and @samp{vec_perm_const@var{m}} if the former can trivially implement
4707 the operation with, say, the vector constant loaded into a register.
4709 @cindex @code{push@var{m}1} instruction pattern
4710 @item @samp{push@var{m}1}
4711 Output a push instruction. Operand 0 is value to push. Used only when
4712 @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined. For historical reason, this pattern may be
4713 missing and in such case an @code{mov} expander is used instead, with a
4714 @code{MEM} expression forming the push operation. The @code{mov} expander
4715 method is deprecated.
4717 @cindex @code{add@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4718 @item @samp{add@var{m}3}
4719 Add operand 2 and operand 1, storing the result in operand 0. All operands
4720 must have mode @var{m}. This can be used even on two-address machines, by
4721 means of constraints requiring operands 1 and 0 to be the same location.
4723 @cindex @code{ssadd@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4724 @cindex @code{usadd@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4725 @cindex @code{sub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4726 @cindex @code{sssub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4727 @cindex @code{ussub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4728 @cindex @code{mul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4729 @cindex @code{ssmul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4730 @cindex @code{usmul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4731 @cindex @code{div@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4732 @cindex @code{ssdiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4733 @cindex @code{udiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4734 @cindex @code{usdiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4735 @cindex @code{mod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4736 @cindex @code{umod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4737 @cindex @code{umin@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4738 @cindex @code{umax@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4739 @cindex @code{and@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4740 @cindex @code{ior@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4741 @cindex @code{xor@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4742 @item @samp{ssadd@var{m}3}, @samp{usadd@var{m}3}
4743 @itemx @samp{sub@var{m}3}, @samp{sssub@var{m}3}, @samp{ussub@var{m}3}
4744 @itemx @samp{mul@var{m}3}, @samp{ssmul@var{m}3}, @samp{usmul@var{m}3}
4745 @itemx @samp{div@var{m}3}, @samp{ssdiv@var{m}3}
4746 @itemx @samp{udiv@var{m}3}, @samp{usdiv@var{m}3}
4747 @itemx @samp{mod@var{m}3}, @samp{umod@var{m}3}
4748 @itemx @samp{umin@var{m}3}, @samp{umax@var{m}3}
4749 @itemx @samp{and@var{m}3}, @samp{ior@var{m}3}, @samp{xor@var{m}3}
4750 Similar, for other arithmetic operations.
4752 @cindex @code{fma@var{m}4} instruction pattern
4753 @item @samp{fma@var{m}4}
4754 Multiply operand 2 and operand 1, then add operand 3, storing the
4755 result in operand 0 without doing an intermediate rounding step. All
4756 operands must have mode @var{m}. This pattern is used to implement
4757 the @code{fma}, @code{fmaf}, and @code{fmal} builtin functions from
4758 the ISO C99 standard.
4760 @cindex @code{fms@var{m}4} instruction pattern
4761 @item @samp{fms@var{m}4}
4762 Like @code{fma@var{m}4}, except operand 3 subtracted from the
4763 product instead of added to the product. This is represented
4767 (fma:@var{m} @var{op1} @var{op2} (neg:@var{m} @var{op3}))
4770 @cindex @code{fnma@var{m}4} instruction pattern
4771 @item @samp{fnma@var{m}4}
4772 Like @code{fma@var{m}4} except that the intermediate product
4773 is negated before being added to operand 3. This is represented
4777 (fma:@var{m} (neg:@var{m} @var{op1}) @var{op2} @var{op3})
4780 @cindex @code{fnms@var{m}4} instruction pattern
4781 @item @samp{fnms@var{m}4}
4782 Like @code{fms@var{m}4} except that the intermediate product
4783 is negated before subtracting operand 3. This is represented
4787 (fma:@var{m} (neg:@var{m} @var{op1}) @var{op2} (neg:@var{m} @var{op3}))
4790 @cindex @code{min@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4791 @cindex @code{max@var{m}3} instruction pattern
4792 @item @samp{smin@var{m}3}, @samp{smax@var{m}3}
4793 Signed minimum and maximum operations. When used with floating point,
4794 if both operands are zeros, or if either operand is @code{NaN}, then
4795 it is unspecified which of the two operands is returned as the result.
4797 @cindex @code{reduc_smin_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4798 @cindex @code{reduc_smax_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4799 @item @samp{reduc_smin_@var{m}}, @samp{reduc_smax_@var{m}}
4800 Find the signed minimum/maximum of the elements of a vector. The vector is
4801 operand 1, and the scalar result is stored in the least significant bits of
4802 operand 0 (also a vector). The output and input vector should have the same
4805 @cindex @code{reduc_umin_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4806 @cindex @code{reduc_umax_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4807 @item @samp{reduc_umin_@var{m}}, @samp{reduc_umax_@var{m}}
4808 Find the unsigned minimum/maximum of the elements of a vector. The vector is
4809 operand 1, and the scalar result is stored in the least significant bits of
4810 operand 0 (also a vector). The output and input vector should have the same
4813 @cindex @code{reduc_splus_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4814 @item @samp{reduc_splus_@var{m}}
4815 Compute the sum of the signed elements of a vector. The vector is operand 1,
4816 and the scalar result is stored in the least significant bits of operand 0
4817 (also a vector). The output and input vector should have the same modes.
4819 @cindex @code{reduc_uplus_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4820 @item @samp{reduc_uplus_@var{m}}
4821 Compute the sum of the unsigned elements of a vector. The vector is operand 1,
4822 and the scalar result is stored in the least significant bits of operand 0
4823 (also a vector). The output and input vector should have the same modes.
4825 @cindex @code{sdot_prod@var{m}} instruction pattern
4826 @item @samp{sdot_prod@var{m}}
4827 @cindex @code{udot_prod@var{m}} instruction pattern
4828 @item @samp{udot_prod@var{m}}
4829 Compute the sum of the products of two signed/unsigned elements.
4830 Operand 1 and operand 2 are of the same mode. Their product, which is of a
4831 wider mode, is computed and added to operand 3. Operand 3 is of a mode equal or
4832 wider than the mode of the product. The result is placed in operand 0, which
4833 is of the same mode as operand 3.
4835 @cindex @code{ssum_widen@var{m3}} instruction pattern
4836 @item @samp{ssum_widen@var{m3}}
4837 @cindex @code{usum_widen@var{m3}} instruction pattern
4838 @item @samp{usum_widen@var{m3}}
4839 Operands 0 and 2 are of the same mode, which is wider than the mode of
4840 operand 1. Add operand 1 to operand 2 and place the widened result in
4841 operand 0. (This is used express accumulation of elements into an accumulator
4844 @cindex @code{vec_shl_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4845 @cindex @code{vec_shr_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4846 @item @samp{vec_shl_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_shr_@var{m}}
4847 Whole vector left/right shift in bits.
4848 Operand 1 is a vector to be shifted.
4849 Operand 2 is an integer shift amount in bits.
4850 Operand 0 is where the resulting shifted vector is stored.
4851 The output and input vectors should have the same modes.
4853 @cindex @code{vec_pack_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4854 @item @samp{vec_pack_trunc_@var{m}}
4855 Narrow (demote) and merge the elements of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2
4856 are vectors of the same mode having N integral or floating point elements
4857 of size S@. Operand 0 is the resulting vector in which 2*N elements of
4858 size N/2 are concatenated after narrowing them down using truncation.
4860 @cindex @code{vec_pack_ssat_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4861 @cindex @code{vec_pack_usat_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4862 @item @samp{vec_pack_ssat_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_pack_usat_@var{m}}
4863 Narrow (demote) and merge the elements of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2
4864 are vectors of the same mode having N integral elements of size S.
4865 Operand 0 is the resulting vector in which the elements of the two input
4866 vectors are concatenated after narrowing them down using signed/unsigned
4867 saturating arithmetic.
4869 @cindex @code{vec_pack_sfix_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4870 @cindex @code{vec_pack_ufix_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4871 @item @samp{vec_pack_sfix_trunc_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_pack_ufix_trunc_@var{m}}
4872 Narrow, convert to signed/unsigned integral type and merge the elements
4873 of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2 are vectors of the same mode having N
4874 floating point elements of size S@. Operand 0 is the resulting vector
4875 in which 2*N elements of size N/2 are concatenated.
4877 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4878 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4879 @item @samp{vec_unpacks_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacks_lo_@var{m}}
4880 Extract and widen (promote) the high/low part of a vector of signed
4881 integral or floating point elements. The input vector (operand 1) has N
4882 elements of size S@. Widen (promote) the high/low elements of the vector
4883 using signed or floating point extension and place the resulting N/2
4884 values of size 2*S in the output vector (operand 0).
4886 @cindex @code{vec_unpacku_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4887 @cindex @code{vec_unpacku_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4888 @item @samp{vec_unpacku_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacku_lo_@var{m}}
4889 Extract and widen (promote) the high/low part of a vector of unsigned
4890 integral elements. The input vector (operand 1) has N elements of size S.
4891 Widen (promote) the high/low elements of the vector using zero extension and
4892 place the resulting N/2 values of size 2*S in the output vector (operand 0).
4894 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_float_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4895 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_float_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4896 @cindex @code{vec_unpacku_float_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4897 @cindex @code{vec_unpacku_float_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4898 @item @samp{vec_unpacks_float_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacks_float_lo_@var{m}}
4899 @itemx @samp{vec_unpacku_float_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacku_float_lo_@var{m}}
4900 Extract, convert to floating point type and widen the high/low part of a
4901 vector of signed/unsigned integral elements. The input vector (operand 1)
4902 has N elements of size S@. Convert the high/low elements of the vector using
4903 floating point conversion and place the resulting N/2 values of size 2*S in
4904 the output vector (operand 0).
4906 @cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4907 @cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4908 @cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4909 @cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4910 @cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_even_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4911 @cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_odd_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4912 @cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_even_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4913 @cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_odd_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4914 @item @samp{vec_widen_umult_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_umult_lo_@var{m}}
4915 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_smult_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_smult_lo_@var{m}}
4916 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_umult_even_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_umult_odd_@var{m}}
4917 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_smult_even_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_smult_odd_@var{m}}
4918 Signed/Unsigned widening multiplication. The two inputs (operands 1 and 2)
4919 are vectors with N signed/unsigned elements of size S@. Multiply the high/low
4920 or even/odd elements of the two vectors, and put the N/2 products of size 2*S
4921 in the output vector (operand 0).
4923 @cindex @code{vec_widen_ushiftl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4924 @cindex @code{vec_widen_ushiftl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4925 @cindex @code{vec_widen_sshiftl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4926 @cindex @code{vec_widen_sshiftl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
4927 @item @samp{vec_widen_ushiftl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_ushiftl_lo_@var{m}}
4928 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_sshiftl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_sshiftl_lo_@var{m}}
4929 Signed/Unsigned widening shift left. The first input (operand 1) is a vector
4930 with N signed/unsigned elements of size S@. Operand 2 is a constant. Shift
4931 the high/low elements of operand 1, and put the N/2 results of size 2*S in the
4932 output vector (operand 0).
4934 @cindex @code{mulhisi3} instruction pattern
4935 @item @samp{mulhisi3}
4936 Multiply operands 1 and 2, which have mode @code{HImode}, and store
4937 a @code{SImode} product in operand 0.
4939 @cindex @code{mulqihi3} instruction pattern
4940 @cindex @code{mulsidi3} instruction pattern
4941 @item @samp{mulqihi3}, @samp{mulsidi3}
4942 Similar widening-multiplication instructions of other widths.
4944 @cindex @code{umulqihi3} instruction pattern
4945 @cindex @code{umulhisi3} instruction pattern
4946 @cindex @code{umulsidi3} instruction pattern
4947 @item @samp{umulqihi3}, @samp{umulhisi3}, @samp{umulsidi3}
4948 Similar widening-multiplication instructions that do unsigned
4951 @cindex @code{usmulqihi3} instruction pattern
4952 @cindex @code{usmulhisi3} instruction pattern
4953 @cindex @code{usmulsidi3} instruction pattern
4954 @item @samp{usmulqihi3}, @samp{usmulhisi3}, @samp{usmulsidi3}
4955 Similar widening-multiplication instructions that interpret the first
4956 operand as unsigned and the second operand as signed, then do a signed
4959 @cindex @code{smul@var{m}3_highpart} instruction pattern
4960 @item @samp{smul@var{m}3_highpart}
4961 Perform a signed multiplication of operands 1 and 2, which have mode
4962 @var{m}, and store the most significant half of the product in operand 0.
4963 The least significant half of the product is discarded.
4965 @cindex @code{umul@var{m}3_highpart} instruction pattern
4966 @item @samp{umul@var{m}3_highpart}
4967 Similar, but the multiplication is unsigned.
4969 @cindex @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
4970 @item @samp{madd@var{m}@var{n}4}
4971 Multiply operands 1 and 2, sign-extend them to mode @var{n}, add
4972 operand 3, and store the result in operand 0. Operands 1 and 2
4973 have mode @var{m} and operands 0 and 3 have mode @var{n}.
4974 Both modes must be integer or fixed-point modes and @var{n} must be twice
4975 the size of @var{m}.
4977 In other words, @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4} is like
4978 @code{mul@var{m}@var{n}3} except that it also adds operand 3.
4980 These instructions are not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4982 @cindex @code{umadd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
4983 @item @samp{umadd@var{m}@var{n}4}
4984 Like @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4}, but zero-extend the multiplication
4985 operands instead of sign-extending them.
4987 @cindex @code{ssmadd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
4988 @item @samp{ssmadd@var{m}@var{n}4}
4989 Like @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
4992 @cindex @code{usmadd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
4993 @item @samp{usmadd@var{m}@var{n}4}
4994 Like @code{umadd@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
4995 unsigned-saturating.
4997 @cindex @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
4998 @item @samp{msub@var{m}@var{n}4}
4999 Multiply operands 1 and 2, sign-extend them to mode @var{n}, subtract the
5000 result from operand 3, and store the result in operand 0. Operands 1 and 2
5001 have mode @var{m} and operands 0 and 3 have mode @var{n}.
5002 Both modes must be integer or fixed-point modes and @var{n} must be twice
5003 the size of @var{m}.
5005 In other words, @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4} is like
5006 @code{mul@var{m}@var{n}3} except that it also subtracts the result
5009 These instructions are not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5011 @cindex @code{umsub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5012 @item @samp{umsub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5013 Like @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4}, but zero-extend the multiplication
5014 operands instead of sign-extending them.
5016 @cindex @code{ssmsub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5017 @item @samp{ssmsub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5018 Like @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5021 @cindex @code{usmsub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5022 @item @samp{usmsub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5023 Like @code{umsub@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5024 unsigned-saturating.
5026 @cindex @code{divmod@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5027 @item @samp{divmod@var{m}4}
5028 Signed division that produces both a quotient and a remainder.
5029 Operand 1 is divided by operand 2 to produce a quotient stored
5030 in operand 0 and a remainder stored in operand 3.
5032 For machines with an instruction that produces both a quotient and a
5033 remainder, provide a pattern for @samp{divmod@var{m}4} but do not
5034 provide patterns for @samp{div@var{m}3} and @samp{mod@var{m}3}. This
5035 allows optimization in the relatively common case when both the quotient
5036 and remainder are computed.
5038 If an instruction that just produces a quotient or just a remainder
5039 exists and is more efficient than the instruction that produces both,
5040 write the output routine of @samp{divmod@var{m}4} to call
5041 @code{find_reg_note} and look for a @code{REG_UNUSED} note on the
5042 quotient or remainder and generate the appropriate instruction.
5044 @cindex @code{udivmod@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5045 @item @samp{udivmod@var{m}4}
5046 Similar, but does unsigned division.
5048 @anchor{shift patterns}
5049 @cindex @code{ashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5050 @cindex @code{ssashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5051 @cindex @code{usashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5052 @item @samp{ashl@var{m}3}, @samp{ssashl@var{m}3}, @samp{usashl@var{m}3}
5053 Arithmetic-shift operand 1 left by a number of bits specified by operand
5054 2, and store the result in operand 0. Here @var{m} is the mode of
5055 operand 0 and operand 1; operand 2's mode is specified by the
5056 instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert the operand to that
5057 mode before generating the instruction. The meaning of out-of-range shift
5058 counts can optionally be specified by @code{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}.
5059 @xref{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}. Operand 2 is always a scalar type.
5061 @cindex @code{ashr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5062 @cindex @code{lshr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5063 @cindex @code{rotl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5064 @cindex @code{rotr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5065 @item @samp{ashr@var{m}3}, @samp{lshr@var{m}3}, @samp{rotl@var{m}3}, @samp{rotr@var{m}3}
5066 Other shift and rotate instructions, analogous to the
5067 @code{ashl@var{m}3} instructions. Operand 2 is always a scalar type.
5069 @cindex @code{vashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5070 @cindex @code{vashr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5071 @cindex @code{vlshr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5072 @cindex @code{vrotl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5073 @cindex @code{vrotr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5074 @item @samp{vashl@var{m}3}, @samp{vashr@var{m}3}, @samp{vlshr@var{m}3}, @samp{vrotl@var{m}3}, @samp{vrotr@var{m}3}
5075 Vector shift and rotate instructions that take vectors as operand 2
5076 instead of a scalar type.
5078 @cindex @code{bswap@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5079 @item @samp{bswap@var{m}2}
5080 Reverse the order of bytes of operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5082 @cindex @code{neg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5083 @cindex @code{ssneg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5084 @cindex @code{usneg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5085 @item @samp{neg@var{m}2}, @samp{ssneg@var{m}2}, @samp{usneg@var{m}2}
5086 Negate operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5088 @cindex @code{abs@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5089 @item @samp{abs@var{m}2}
5090 Store the absolute value of operand 1 into operand 0.
5092 @cindex @code{sqrt@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5093 @item @samp{sqrt@var{m}2}
5094 Store the square root of operand 1 into operand 0.
5096 The @code{sqrt} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5097 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{sqrtf}
5098 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5101 @cindex @code{fmod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5102 @item @samp{fmod@var{m}3}
5103 Store the remainder of dividing operand 1 by operand 2 into
5104 operand 0, rounded towards zero to an integer.
5106 The @code{fmod} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5107 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{fmodf}
5108 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5111 @cindex @code{remainder@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5112 @item @samp{remainder@var{m}3}
5113 Store the remainder of dividing operand 1 by operand 2 into
5114 operand 0, rounded to the nearest integer.
5116 The @code{remainder} built-in function of C always uses the mode
5117 which corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the
5118 @code{remainderf} built-in function uses the mode which corresponds
5119 to the C data type @code{float}.
5121 @cindex @code{cos@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5122 @item @samp{cos@var{m}2}
5123 Store the cosine of operand 1 into operand 0.
5125 The @code{cos} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5126 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{cosf}
5127 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5130 @cindex @code{sin@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5131 @item @samp{sin@var{m}2}
5132 Store the sine of operand 1 into operand 0.
5134 The @code{sin} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5135 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{sinf}
5136 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5139 @cindex @code{sincos@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5140 @item @samp{sincos@var{m}3}
5141 Store the cosine of operand 2 into operand 0 and the sine of
5142 operand 2 into operand 1.
5144 The @code{sin} and @code{cos} built-in functions of C always use the
5145 mode which corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the
5146 @code{sinf} and @code{cosf} built-in function use the mode which
5147 corresponds to the C data type @code{float}.
5148 Targets that can calculate the sine and cosine simultaneously can
5149 implement this pattern as opposed to implementing individual
5150 @code{sin@var{m}2} and @code{cos@var{m}2} patterns. The @code{sin}
5151 and @code{cos} built-in functions will then be expanded to the
5152 @code{sincos@var{m}3} pattern, with one of the output values
5155 @cindex @code{exp@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5156 @item @samp{exp@var{m}2}
5157 Store the exponential of operand 1 into operand 0.
5159 The @code{exp} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5160 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{expf}
5161 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5164 @cindex @code{log@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5165 @item @samp{log@var{m}2}
5166 Store the natural logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0.
5168 The @code{log} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5169 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{logf}
5170 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5173 @cindex @code{pow@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5174 @item @samp{pow@var{m}3}
5175 Store the value of operand 1 raised to the exponent operand 2
5178 The @code{pow} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5179 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{powf}
5180 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5183 @cindex @code{atan2@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5184 @item @samp{atan2@var{m}3}
5185 Store the arc tangent (inverse tangent) of operand 1 divided by
5186 operand 2 into operand 0, using the signs of both arguments to
5187 determine the quadrant of the result.
5189 The @code{atan2} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5190 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{atan2f}
5191 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5194 @cindex @code{floor@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5195 @item @samp{floor@var{m}2}
5196 Store the largest integral value not greater than argument.
5198 The @code{floor} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5199 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{floorf}
5200 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5203 @cindex @code{btrunc@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5204 @item @samp{btrunc@var{m}2}
5205 Store the argument rounded to integer towards zero.
5207 The @code{trunc} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5208 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{truncf}
5209 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5212 @cindex @code{round@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5213 @item @samp{round@var{m}2}
5214 Store the argument rounded to integer away from zero.
5216 The @code{round} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5217 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{roundf}
5218 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5221 @cindex @code{ceil@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5222 @item @samp{ceil@var{m}2}
5223 Store the argument rounded to integer away from zero.
5225 The @code{ceil} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5226 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{ceilf}
5227 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5230 @cindex @code{nearbyint@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5231 @item @samp{nearbyint@var{m}2}
5232 Store the argument rounded according to the default rounding mode
5234 The @code{nearbyint} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5235 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{nearbyintf}
5236 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5239 @cindex @code{rint@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5240 @item @samp{rint@var{m}2}
5241 Store the argument rounded according to the default rounding mode and
5242 raise the inexact exception when the result differs in value from
5245 The @code{rint} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5246 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{rintf}
5247 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5250 @cindex @code{lrint@var{m}@var{n}2}
5251 @item @samp{lrint@var{m}@var{n}2}
5252 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5253 point mode @var{n} as a signed number according to the current
5254 rounding mode and store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
5256 @cindex @code{lround@var{m}@var{n}2}
5257 @item @samp{lround@var{m}@var{n}2}
5258 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5259 point mode @var{n} as a signed number rounding to nearest and away
5260 from zero and store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
5262 @cindex @code{lfloor@var{m}@var{n}2}
5263 @item @samp{lfloor@var{m}@var{n}2}
5264 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5265 point mode @var{n} as a signed number rounding down and store in
5266 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
5268 @cindex @code{lceil@var{m}@var{n}2}
5269 @item @samp{lceil@var{m}@var{n}2}
5270 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5271 point mode @var{n} as a signed number rounding up and store in
5272 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
5274 @cindex @code{copysign@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5275 @item @samp{copysign@var{m}3}
5276 Store a value with the magnitude of operand 1 and the sign of operand
5279 The @code{copysign} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5280 corresponds to the C data type @code{double} and the @code{copysignf}
5281 built-in function uses the mode which corresponds to the C data
5284 @cindex @code{ffs@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5285 @item @samp{ffs@var{m}2}
5286 Store into operand 0 one plus the index of the least significant 1-bit
5287 of operand 1. If operand 1 is zero, store zero. @var{m} is the mode
5288 of operand 0; operand 1's mode is specified by the instruction
5289 pattern, and the compiler will convert the operand to that mode before
5290 generating the instruction.
5292 The @code{ffs} built-in function of C always uses the mode which
5293 corresponds to the C data type @code{int}.
5295 @cindex @code{clz@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5296 @item @samp{clz@var{m}2}
5297 Store into operand 0 the number of leading 0-bits in @var{x}, starting
5298 at the most significant bit position. If @var{x} is 0, the
5299 @code{CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO} (@pxref{Misc}) macro defines if
5300 the result is undefined or has a useful value.
5301 @var{m} is the mode of operand 0; operand 1's mode is
5302 specified by the instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert the
5303 operand to that mode before generating the instruction.
5305 @cindex @code{ctz@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5306 @item @samp{ctz@var{m}2}
5307 Store into operand 0 the number of trailing 0-bits in @var{x}, starting
5308 at the least significant bit position. If @var{x} is 0, the
5309 @code{CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO} (@pxref{Misc}) macro defines if
5310 the result is undefined or has a useful value.
5311 @var{m} is the mode of operand 0; operand 1's mode is
5312 specified by the instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert the
5313 operand to that mode before generating the instruction.
5315 @cindex @code{popcount@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5316 @item @samp{popcount@var{m}2}
5317 Store into operand 0 the number of 1-bits in @var{x}. @var{m} is the
5318 mode of operand 0; operand 1's mode is specified by the instruction
5319 pattern, and the compiler will convert the operand to that mode before
5320 generating the instruction.
5322 @cindex @code{parity@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5323 @item @samp{parity@var{m}2}
5324 Store into operand 0 the parity of @var{x}, i.e.@: the number of 1-bits
5325 in @var{x} modulo 2. @var{m} is the mode of operand 0; operand 1's mode
5326 is specified by the instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert
5327 the operand to that mode before generating the instruction.
5329 @cindex @code{one_cmpl@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5330 @item @samp{one_cmpl@var{m}2}
5331 Store the bitwise-complement of operand 1 into operand 0.
5333 @cindex @code{movmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
5334 @item @samp{movmem@var{m}}
5335 Block move instruction. The destination and source blocks of memory
5336 are the first two operands, and both are @code{mem:BLK}s with an
5337 address in mode @code{Pmode}.
5339 The number of bytes to move is the third operand, in mode @var{m}.
5340 Usually, you specify @code{Pmode} for @var{m}. However, if you can
5341 generate better code knowing the range of valid lengths is smaller than
5342 those representable in a full Pmode pointer, you should provide
5344 mode corresponding to the range of values you can handle efficiently
5345 (e.g., @code{QImode} for values in the range 0--127; note we avoid numbers
5346 that appear negative) and also a pattern with @code{Pmode}.
5348 The fourth operand is the known shared alignment of the source and
5349 destination, in the form of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the
5350 compiler knows that both source and destination are word-aligned,
5351 it may provide the value 4 for this operand.
5353 Optional operands 5 and 6 specify expected alignment and size of block
5354 respectively. The expected alignment differs from alignment in operand 4
5355 in a way that the blocks are not required to be aligned according to it in
5356 all cases. This expected alignment is also in bytes, just like operand 4.
5357 Expected size, when unknown, is set to @code{(const_int -1)}.
5359 Descriptions of multiple @code{movmem@var{m}} patterns can only be
5360 beneficial if the patterns for smaller modes have fewer restrictions
5361 on their first, second and fourth operands. Note that the mode @var{m}
5362 in @code{movmem@var{m}} does not impose any restriction on the mode of
5363 individually moved data units in the block.
5365 These patterns need not give special consideration to the possibility
5366 that the source and destination strings might overlap.
5368 @cindex @code{movstr} instruction pattern
5370 String copy instruction, with @code{stpcpy} semantics. Operand 0 is
5371 an output operand in mode @code{Pmode}. The addresses of the
5372 destination and source strings are operands 1 and 2, and both are
5373 @code{mem:BLK}s with addresses in mode @code{Pmode}. The execution of
5374 the expansion of this pattern should store in operand 0 the address in
5375 which the @code{NUL} terminator was stored in the destination string.
5377 This patern has also several optional operands that are same as in
5380 @cindex @code{setmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
5381 @item @samp{setmem@var{m}}
5382 Block set instruction. The destination string is the first operand,
5383 given as a @code{mem:BLK} whose address is in mode @code{Pmode}. The
5384 number of bytes to set is the second operand, in mode @var{m}. The value to
5385 initialize the memory with is the third operand. Targets that only support the
5386 clearing of memory should reject any value that is not the constant 0. See
5387 @samp{movmem@var{m}} for a discussion of the choice of mode.
5389 The fourth operand is the known alignment of the destination, in the form
5390 of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the compiler knows that the
5391 destination is word-aligned, it may provide the value 4 for this
5394 Optional operands 5 and 6 specify expected alignment and size of block
5395 respectively. The expected alignment differs from alignment in operand 4
5396 in a way that the blocks are not required to be aligned according to it in
5397 all cases. This expected alignment is also in bytes, just like operand 4.
5398 Expected size, when unknown, is set to @code{(const_int -1)}.
5399 Operand 7 is the minimal size of the block and operand 8 is the
5400 maximal size of the block (NULL if it can not be represented as CONST_INT).
5401 Operand 9 is the probable maximal size (i.e. we can not rely on it for correctness,
5402 but it can be used for choosing proper code sequence for a given size).
5404 The use for multiple @code{setmem@var{m}} is as for @code{movmem@var{m}}.
5406 @cindex @code{cmpstrn@var{m}} instruction pattern
5407 @item @samp{cmpstrn@var{m}}
5408 String compare instruction, with five operands. Operand 0 is the output;
5409 it has mode @var{m}. The remaining four operands are like the operands
5410 of @samp{movmem@var{m}}. The two memory blocks specified are compared
5411 byte by byte in lexicographic order starting at the beginning of each
5412 string. The instruction is not allowed to prefetch more than one byte
5413 at a time since either string may end in the first byte and reading past
5414 that may access an invalid page or segment and cause a fault. The
5415 comparison terminates early if the fetched bytes are different or if
5416 they are equal to zero. The effect of the instruction is to store a
5417 value in operand 0 whose sign indicates the result of the comparison.
5419 @cindex @code{cmpstr@var{m}} instruction pattern
5420 @item @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}
5421 String compare instruction, without known maximum length. Operand 0 is the
5422 output; it has mode @var{m}. The second and third operand are the blocks of
5423 memory to be compared; both are @code{mem:BLK} with an address in mode
5426 The fourth operand is the known shared alignment of the source and
5427 destination, in the form of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the
5428 compiler knows that both source and destination are word-aligned,
5429 it may provide the value 4 for this operand.
5431 The two memory blocks specified are compared byte by byte in lexicographic
5432 order starting at the beginning of each string. The instruction is not allowed
5433 to prefetch more than one byte at a time since either string may end in the
5434 first byte and reading past that may access an invalid page or segment and
5435 cause a fault. The comparison will terminate when the fetched bytes
5436 are different or if they are equal to zero. The effect of the
5437 instruction is to store a value in operand 0 whose sign indicates the
5438 result of the comparison.
5440 @cindex @code{cmpmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
5441 @item @samp{cmpmem@var{m}}
5442 Block compare instruction, with five operands like the operands
5443 of @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}. The two memory blocks specified are compared
5444 byte by byte in lexicographic order starting at the beginning of each
5445 block. Unlike @samp{cmpstr@var{m}} the instruction can prefetch
5446 any bytes in the two memory blocks. Also unlike @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}
5447 the comparison will not stop if both bytes are zero. The effect of
5448 the instruction is to store a value in operand 0 whose sign indicates
5449 the result of the comparison.
5451 @cindex @code{strlen@var{m}} instruction pattern
5452 @item @samp{strlen@var{m}}
5453 Compute the length of a string, with three operands.
5454 Operand 0 is the result (of mode @var{m}), operand 1 is
5455 a @code{mem} referring to the first character of the string,
5456 operand 2 is the character to search for (normally zero),
5457 and operand 3 is a constant describing the known alignment
5458 of the beginning of the string.
5460 @cindex @code{float@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5461 @item @samp{float@var{m}@var{n}2}
5462 Convert signed integer operand 1 (valid for fixed point mode @var{m}) to
5463 floating point mode @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode
5466 @cindex @code{floatuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5467 @item @samp{floatuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
5468 Convert unsigned integer operand 1 (valid for fixed point mode @var{m})
5469 to floating point mode @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode
5472 @cindex @code{fix@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5473 @item @samp{fix@var{m}@var{n}2}
5474 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5475 point mode @var{n} as a signed number and store in operand 0 (which
5476 has mode @var{n}). This instruction's result is defined only when
5477 the value of operand 1 is an integer.
5479 If the machine description defines this pattern, it also needs to
5480 define the @code{ftrunc} pattern.
5482 @cindex @code{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5483 @item @samp{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
5484 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
5485 point mode @var{n} as an unsigned number and store in operand 0 (which
5486 has mode @var{n}). This instruction's result is defined only when the
5487 value of operand 1 is an integer.
5489 @cindex @code{ftrunc@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5490 @item @samp{ftrunc@var{m}2}
5491 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to an
5492 integer value, still represented in floating point mode @var{m}, and
5493 store it in operand 0 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}).
5495 @cindex @code{fix_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5496 @item @samp{fix_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
5497 Like @samp{fix@var{m}@var{n}2} but works for any floating point value
5498 of mode @var{m} by converting the value to an integer.
5500 @cindex @code{fixuns_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5501 @item @samp{fixuns_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
5502 Like @samp{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2} but works for any floating point
5503 value of mode @var{m} by converting the value to an integer.
5505 @cindex @code{trunc@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5506 @item @samp{trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
5507 Truncate operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
5508 store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
5509 point or both floating point.
5511 @cindex @code{extend@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5512 @item @samp{extend@var{m}@var{n}2}
5513 Sign-extend operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
5514 store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
5515 point or both floating point.
5517 @cindex @code{zero_extend@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5518 @item @samp{zero_extend@var{m}@var{n}2}
5519 Zero-extend operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
5520 store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
5523 @cindex @code{fract@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5524 @item @samp{fract@var{m}@var{n}2}
5525 Convert operand 1 of mode @var{m} to mode @var{n} and store in
5526 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Mode @var{m} and mode @var{n}
5527 could be fixed-point to fixed-point, signed integer to fixed-point,
5528 fixed-point to signed integer, floating-point to fixed-point,
5529 or fixed-point to floating-point.
5530 When overflows or underflows happen, the results are undefined.
5532 @cindex @code{satfract@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5533 @item @samp{satfract@var{m}@var{n}2}
5534 Convert operand 1 of mode @var{m} to mode @var{n} and store in
5535 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Mode @var{m} and mode @var{n}
5536 could be fixed-point to fixed-point, signed integer to fixed-point,
5537 or floating-point to fixed-point.
5538 When overflows or underflows happen, the instruction saturates the
5539 results to the maximum or the minimum.
5541 @cindex @code{fractuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5542 @item @samp{fractuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
5543 Convert operand 1 of mode @var{m} to mode @var{n} and store in
5544 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Mode @var{m} and mode @var{n}
5545 could be unsigned integer to fixed-point, or
5546 fixed-point to unsigned integer.
5547 When overflows or underflows happen, the results are undefined.
5549 @cindex @code{satfractuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
5550 @item @samp{satfractuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
5551 Convert unsigned integer operand 1 of mode @var{m} to fixed-point mode
5552 @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
5553 When overflows or underflows happen, the instruction saturates the
5554 results to the maximum or the minimum.
5556 @cindex @code{extv@var{m}} instruction pattern
5557 @item @samp{extv@var{m}}
5558 Extract a bit-field from register operand 1, sign-extend it, and store
5559 it in operand 0. Operand 2 specifies the width of the field in bits
5560 and operand 3 the starting bit, which counts from the most significant
5561 bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN} is true and from the least significant bit
5564 Operands 0 and 1 both have mode @var{m}. Operands 2 and 3 have a
5565 target-specific mode.
5567 @cindex @code{extvmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
5568 @item @samp{extvmisalign@var{m}}
5569 Extract a bit-field from memory operand 1, sign extend it, and store
5570 it in operand 0. Operand 2 specifies the width in bits and operand 3
5571 the starting bit. The starting bit is always somewhere in the first byte of
5572 operand 1; it counts from the most significant bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN}
5573 is true and from the least significant bit otherwise.
5575 Operand 0 has mode @var{m} while operand 1 has @code{BLK} mode.
5576 Operands 2 and 3 have a target-specific mode.
5578 The instruction must not read beyond the last byte of the bit-field.
5580 @cindex @code{extzv@var{m}} instruction pattern
5581 @item @samp{extzv@var{m}}
5582 Like @samp{extv@var{m}} except that the bit-field value is zero-extended.
5584 @cindex @code{extzvmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
5585 @item @samp{extzvmisalign@var{m}}
5586 Like @samp{extvmisalign@var{m}} except that the bit-field value is
5589 @cindex @code{insv@var{m}} instruction pattern
5590 @item @samp{insv@var{m}}
5591 Insert operand 3 into a bit-field of register operand 0. Operand 1
5592 specifies the width of the field in bits and operand 2 the starting bit,
5593 which counts from the most significant bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN}
5594 is true and from the least significant bit otherwise.
5596 Operands 0 and 3 both have mode @var{m}. Operands 1 and 2 have a
5597 target-specific mode.
5599 @cindex @code{insvmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
5600 @item @samp{insvmisalign@var{m}}
5601 Insert operand 3 into a bit-field of memory operand 0. Operand 1
5602 specifies the width of the field in bits and operand 2 the starting bit.
5603 The starting bit is always somewhere in the first byte of operand 0;
5604 it counts from the most significant bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN}
5605 is true and from the least significant bit otherwise.
5607 Operand 3 has mode @var{m} while operand 0 has @code{BLK} mode.
5608 Operands 1 and 2 have a target-specific mode.
5610 The instruction must not read or write beyond the last byte of the bit-field.
5612 @cindex @code{extv} instruction pattern
5614 Extract a bit-field from operand 1 (a register or memory operand), where
5615 operand 2 specifies the width in bits and operand 3 the starting bit,
5616 and store it in operand 0. Operand 0 must have mode @code{word_mode}.
5617 Operand 1 may have mode @code{byte_mode} or @code{word_mode}; often
5618 @code{word_mode} is allowed only for registers. Operands 2 and 3 must
5619 be valid for @code{word_mode}.
5621 The RTL generation pass generates this instruction only with constants
5622 for operands 2 and 3 and the constant is never zero for operand 2.
5624 The bit-field value is sign-extended to a full word integer
5625 before it is stored in operand 0.
5627 This pattern is deprecated; please use @samp{extv@var{m}} and
5628 @code{extvmisalign@var{m}} instead.
5630 @cindex @code{extzv} instruction pattern
5632 Like @samp{extv} except that the bit-field value is zero-extended.
5634 This pattern is deprecated; please use @samp{extzv@var{m}} and
5635 @code{extzvmisalign@var{m}} instead.
5637 @cindex @code{insv} instruction pattern
5639 Store operand 3 (which must be valid for @code{word_mode}) into a
5640 bit-field in operand 0, where operand 1 specifies the width in bits and
5641 operand 2 the starting bit. Operand 0 may have mode @code{byte_mode} or
5642 @code{word_mode}; often @code{word_mode} is allowed only for registers.
5643 Operands 1 and 2 must be valid for @code{word_mode}.
5645 The RTL generation pass generates this instruction only with constants
5646 for operands 1 and 2 and the constant is never zero for operand 1.
5648 This pattern is deprecated; please use @samp{insv@var{m}} and
5649 @code{insvmisalign@var{m}} instead.
5651 @cindex @code{mov@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
5652 @item @samp{mov@var{mode}cc}
5653 Conditionally move operand 2 or operand 3 into operand 0 according to the
5654 comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is true, operand 2 is moved
5655 into operand 0, otherwise operand 3 is moved.
5657 The mode of the operands being compared need not be the same as the operands
5658 being moved. Some machines, sparc64 for example, have instructions that
5659 conditionally move an integer value based on the floating point condition
5660 codes and vice versa.
5662 If the machine does not have conditional move instructions, do not
5663 define these patterns.
5665 @cindex @code{add@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
5666 @item @samp{add@var{mode}cc}
5667 Similar to @samp{mov@var{mode}cc} but for conditional addition. Conditionally
5668 move operand 2 or (operands 2 + operand 3) into operand 0 according to the
5669 comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is false, operand 2 is moved into
5670 operand 0, otherwise (operand 2 + operand 3) is moved.
5672 @cindex @code{cstore@var{mode}4} instruction pattern
5673 @item @samp{cstore@var{mode}4}
5674 Store zero or nonzero in operand 0 according to whether a comparison
5675 is true. Operand 1 is a comparison operator. Operand 2 and operand 3
5676 are the first and second operand of the comparison, respectively.
5677 You specify the mode that operand 0 must have when you write the
5678 @code{match_operand} expression. The compiler automatically sees which
5679 mode you have used and supplies an operand of that mode.
5681 The value stored for a true condition must have 1 as its low bit, or
5682 else must be negative. Otherwise the instruction is not suitable and
5683 you should omit it from the machine description. You describe to the
5684 compiler exactly which value is stored by defining the macro
5685 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} (@pxref{Misc}). If a description cannot be
5686 found that can be used for all the possible comparison operators, you
5687 should pick one and use a @code{define_expand} to map all results
5688 onto the one you chose.
5690 These operations may @code{FAIL}, but should do so only in relatively
5691 uncommon cases; if they would @code{FAIL} for common cases involving
5692 integer comparisons, it is best to restrict the predicates to not
5693 allow these operands. Likewise if a given comparison operator will
5694 always fail, independent of the operands (for floating-point modes, the
5695 @code{ordered_comparison_operator} predicate is often useful in this case).
5697 If this pattern is omitted, the compiler will generate a conditional
5698 branch---for example, it may copy a constant one to the target and branching
5699 around an assignment of zero to the target---or a libcall. If the predicate
5700 for operand 1 only rejects some operators, it will also try reordering the
5701 operands and/or inverting the result value (e.g.@: by an exclusive OR).
5702 These possibilities could be cheaper or equivalent to the instructions
5703 used for the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern followed by those required
5704 to convert a positive result from @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} to 1; in this
5705 case, you can and should make operand 1's predicate reject some operators
5706 in the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern, or remove the pattern altogether
5707 from the machine description.
5709 @cindex @code{cbranch@var{mode}4} instruction pattern
5710 @item @samp{cbranch@var{mode}4}
5711 Conditional branch instruction combined with a compare instruction.
5712 Operand 0 is a comparison operator. Operand 1 and operand 2 are the
5713 first and second operands of the comparison, respectively. Operand 3
5714 is a @code{label_ref} that refers to the label to jump to.
5716 @cindex @code{jump} instruction pattern
5718 A jump inside a function; an unconditional branch. Operand 0 is the
5719 @code{label_ref} of the label to jump to. This pattern name is mandatory
5722 @cindex @code{call} instruction pattern
5724 Subroutine call instruction returning no value. Operand 0 is the
5725 function to call; operand 1 is the number of bytes of arguments pushed
5726 as a @code{const_int}; operand 2 is the number of registers used as
5729 On most machines, operand 2 is not actually stored into the RTL
5730 pattern. It is supplied for the sake of some RISC machines which need
5731 to put this information into the assembler code; they can put it in
5732 the RTL instead of operand 1.
5734 Operand 0 should be a @code{mem} RTX whose address is the address of the
5735 function. Note, however, that this address can be a @code{symbol_ref}
5736 expression even if it would not be a legitimate memory address on the
5737 target machine. If it is also not a valid argument for a call
5738 instruction, the pattern for this operation should be a
5739 @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions}) that places the
5740 address into a register and uses that register in the call instruction.
5742 @cindex @code{call_value} instruction pattern
5743 @item @samp{call_value}
5744 Subroutine call instruction returning a value. Operand 0 is the hard
5745 register in which the value is returned. There are three more
5746 operands, the same as the three operands of the @samp{call}
5747 instruction (but with numbers increased by one).
5749 Subroutines that return @code{BLKmode} objects use the @samp{call}
5752 @cindex @code{call_pop} instruction pattern
5753 @cindex @code{call_value_pop} instruction pattern
5754 @item @samp{call_pop}, @samp{call_value_pop}
5755 Similar to @samp{call} and @samp{call_value}, except used if defined and
5756 if @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is nonzero. They should emit a @code{parallel}
5757 that contains both the function call and a @code{set} to indicate the
5758 adjustment made to the frame pointer.
5760 For machines where @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} can be nonzero, the use of these
5761 patterns increases the number of functions for which the frame pointer
5762 can be eliminated, if desired.
5764 @cindex @code{untyped_call} instruction pattern
5765 @item @samp{untyped_call}
5766 Subroutine call instruction returning a value of any type. Operand 0 is
5767 the function to call; operand 1 is a memory location where the result of
5768 calling the function is to be stored; operand 2 is a @code{parallel}
5769 expression where each element is a @code{set} expression that indicates
5770 the saving of a function return value into the result block.
5772 This instruction pattern should be defined to support
5773 @code{__builtin_apply} on machines where special instructions are needed
5774 to call a subroutine with arbitrary arguments or to save the value
5775 returned. This instruction pattern is required on machines that have
5776 multiple registers that can hold a return value
5777 (i.e.@: @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} is true for more than one register).
5779 @cindex @code{return} instruction pattern
5781 Subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern name should be
5782 defined only if a single instruction can do all the work of returning
5785 Like the @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, this pattern is also used after the
5786 RTL generation phase. In this case it is to support machines where
5787 multiple instructions are usually needed to return from a function, but
5788 some class of functions only requires one instruction to implement a
5789 return. Normally, the applicable functions are those which do not need
5790 to save any registers or allocate stack space.
5792 It is valid for this pattern to expand to an instruction using
5793 @code{simple_return} if no epilogue is required.
5795 @cindex @code{simple_return} instruction pattern
5796 @item @samp{simple_return}
5797 Subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern name should be
5798 defined only if a single instruction can do all the work of returning
5799 from a function on a path where no epilogue is required. This pattern
5800 is very similar to the @code{return} instruction pattern, but it is emitted
5801 only by the shrink-wrapping optimization on paths where the function
5802 prologue has not been executed, and a function return should occur without
5803 any of the effects of the epilogue. Additional uses may be introduced on
5804 paths where both the prologue and the epilogue have executed.
5806 @findex reload_completed
5807 @findex leaf_function_p
5808 For such machines, the condition specified in this pattern should only
5809 be true when @code{reload_completed} is nonzero and the function's
5810 epilogue would only be a single instruction. For machines with register
5811 windows, the routine @code{leaf_function_p} may be used to determine if
5812 a register window push is required.
5814 Machines that have conditional return instructions should define patterns
5820 (if_then_else (match_operator
5821 0 "comparison_operator"
5822 [(cc0) (const_int 0)])
5829 where @var{condition} would normally be the same condition specified on the
5830 named @samp{return} pattern.
5832 @cindex @code{untyped_return} instruction pattern
5833 @item @samp{untyped_return}
5834 Untyped subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern should
5835 be defined to support @code{__builtin_return} on machines where special
5836 instructions are needed to return a value of any type.
5838 Operand 0 is a memory location where the result of calling a function
5839 with @code{__builtin_apply} is stored; operand 1 is a @code{parallel}
5840 expression where each element is a @code{set} expression that indicates
5841 the restoring of a function return value from the result block.
5843 @cindex @code{nop} instruction pattern
5845 No-op instruction. This instruction pattern name should always be defined
5846 to output a no-op in assembler code. @code{(const_int 0)} will do as an
5849 @cindex @code{indirect_jump} instruction pattern
5850 @item @samp{indirect_jump}
5851 An instruction to jump to an address which is operand zero.
5852 This pattern name is mandatory on all machines.
5854 @cindex @code{casesi} instruction pattern
5856 Instruction to jump through a dispatch table, including bounds checking.
5857 This instruction takes five operands:
5861 The index to dispatch on, which has mode @code{SImode}.
5864 The lower bound for indices in the table, an integer constant.
5867 The total range of indices in the table---the largest index
5868 minus the smallest one (both inclusive).
5871 A label that precedes the table itself.
5874 A label to jump to if the index has a value outside the bounds.
5877 The table is an @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec} inside of a
5878 @code{jump_table_data}. The number of elements in the table is one plus the
5879 difference between the upper bound and the lower bound.
5881 @cindex @code{tablejump} instruction pattern
5882 @item @samp{tablejump}
5883 Instruction to jump to a variable address. This is a low-level
5884 capability which can be used to implement a dispatch table when there
5885 is no @samp{casesi} pattern.
5887 This pattern requires two operands: the address or offset, and a label
5888 which should immediately precede the jump table. If the macro
5889 @code{CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE} evaluates to a nonzero value then the first
5890 operand is an offset which counts from the address of the table; otherwise,
5891 it is an absolute address to jump to. In either case, the first operand has
5894 The @samp{tablejump} insn is always the last insn before the jump
5895 table it uses. Its assembler code normally has no need to use the
5896 second operand, but you should incorporate it in the RTL pattern so
5897 that the jump optimizer will not delete the table as unreachable code.
5900 @cindex @code{decrement_and_branch_until_zero} instruction pattern
5901 @item @samp{decrement_and_branch_until_zero}
5902 Conditional branch instruction that decrements a register and
5903 jumps if the register is nonzero. Operand 0 is the register to
5904 decrement and test; operand 1 is the label to jump to if the
5905 register is nonzero. @xref{Looping Patterns}.
5907 This optional instruction pattern is only used by the combiner,
5908 typically for loops reversed by the loop optimizer when strength
5909 reduction is enabled.
5911 @cindex @code{doloop_end} instruction pattern
5912 @item @samp{doloop_end}
5913 Conditional branch instruction that decrements a register and
5914 jumps if the register is nonzero. Operand 0 is the register to
5915 decrement and test; operand 1 is the label to jump to if the
5916 register is nonzero.
5917 @xref{Looping Patterns}.
5919 This optional instruction pattern should be defined for machines with
5920 low-overhead looping instructions as the loop optimizer will try to
5921 modify suitable loops to utilize it. The target hook
5922 @code{TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P} controls the conditions under which
5923 low-overhead loops can be used.
5925 @cindex @code{doloop_begin} instruction pattern
5926 @item @samp{doloop_begin}
5927 Companion instruction to @code{doloop_end} required for machines that
5928 need to perform some initialization, such as loading a special counter
5929 register. Operand 1 is the associated @code{doloop_end} pattern and
5930 operand 0 is the register that it decrements.
5932 If initialization insns do not always need to be emitted, use a
5933 @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions}) and make it fail.
5935 @cindex @code{canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare} instruction pattern
5936 @item @samp{canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare}
5937 Canonicalize the function pointer in operand 1 and store the result
5940 Operand 0 is always a @code{reg} and has mode @code{Pmode}; operand 1
5941 may be a @code{reg}, @code{mem}, @code{symbol_ref}, @code{const_int}, etc
5942 and also has mode @code{Pmode}.
5944 Canonicalization of a function pointer usually involves computing
5945 the address of the function which would be called if the function
5946 pointer were used in an indirect call.
5948 Only define this pattern if function pointers on the target machine
5949 can have different values but still call the same function when
5950 used in an indirect call.
5952 @cindex @code{save_stack_block} instruction pattern
5953 @cindex @code{save_stack_function} instruction pattern
5954 @cindex @code{save_stack_nonlocal} instruction pattern
5955 @cindex @code{restore_stack_block} instruction pattern
5956 @cindex @code{restore_stack_function} instruction pattern
5957 @cindex @code{restore_stack_nonlocal} instruction pattern
5958 @item @samp{save_stack_block}
5959 @itemx @samp{save_stack_function}
5960 @itemx @samp{save_stack_nonlocal}
5961 @itemx @samp{restore_stack_block}
5962 @itemx @samp{restore_stack_function}
5963 @itemx @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal}
5964 Most machines save and restore the stack pointer by copying it to or
5965 from an object of mode @code{Pmode}. Do not define these patterns on
5968 Some machines require special handling for stack pointer saves and
5969 restores. On those machines, define the patterns corresponding to the
5970 non-standard cases by using a @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander
5971 Definitions}) that produces the required insns. The three types of
5972 saves and restores are:
5976 @samp{save_stack_block} saves the stack pointer at the start of a block
5977 that allocates a variable-sized object, and @samp{restore_stack_block}
5978 restores the stack pointer when the block is exited.
5981 @samp{save_stack_function} and @samp{restore_stack_function} do a
5982 similar job for the outermost block of a function and are used when the
5983 function allocates variable-sized objects or calls @code{alloca}. Only
5984 the epilogue uses the restored stack pointer, allowing a simpler save or
5985 restore sequence on some machines.
5988 @samp{save_stack_nonlocal} is used in functions that contain labels
5989 branched to by nested functions. It saves the stack pointer in such a
5990 way that the inner function can use @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal} to
5991 restore the stack pointer. The compiler generates code to restore the
5992 frame and argument pointer registers, but some machines require saving
5993 and restoring additional data such as register window information or
5994 stack backchains. Place insns in these patterns to save and restore any
5998 When saving the stack pointer, operand 0 is the save area and operand 1
5999 is the stack pointer. The mode used to allocate the save area defaults
6000 to @code{Pmode} but you can override that choice by defining the
6001 @code{STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE} macro (@pxref{Storage Layout}). You must
6002 specify an integral mode, or @code{VOIDmode} if no save area is needed
6003 for a particular type of save (either because no save is needed or
6004 because a machine-specific save area can be used). Operand 0 is the
6005 stack pointer and operand 1 is the save area for restore operations. If
6006 @samp{save_stack_block} is defined, operand 0 must not be
6007 @code{VOIDmode} since these saves can be arbitrarily nested.
6009 A save area is a @code{mem} that is at a constant offset from
6010 @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx} when the stack pointer is saved for use by
6011 nonlocal gotos and a @code{reg} in the other two cases.
6013 @cindex @code{allocate_stack} instruction pattern
6014 @item @samp{allocate_stack}
6015 Subtract (or add if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is undefined) operand 1 from
6016 the stack pointer to create space for dynamically allocated data.
6018 Store the resultant pointer to this space into operand 0. If you
6019 are allocating space from the main stack, do this by emitting a
6020 move insn to copy @code{virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx} to operand 0.
6021 If you are allocating the space elsewhere, generate code to copy the
6022 location of the space to operand 0. In the latter case, you must
6023 ensure this space gets freed when the corresponding space on the main
6026 Do not define this pattern if all that must be done is the subtraction.
6027 Some machines require other operations such as stack probes or
6028 maintaining the back chain. Define this pattern to emit those
6029 operations in addition to updating the stack pointer.
6031 @cindex @code{check_stack} instruction pattern
6032 @item @samp{check_stack}
6033 If stack checking (@pxref{Stack Checking}) cannot be done on your system by
6034 probing the stack, define this pattern to perform the needed check and signal
6035 an error if the stack has overflowed. The single operand is the address in
6036 the stack farthest from the current stack pointer that you need to validate.
6037 Normally, on platforms where this pattern is needed, you would obtain the
6038 stack limit from a global or thread-specific variable or register.
6040 @cindex @code{probe_stack_address} instruction pattern
6041 @item @samp{probe_stack_address}
6042 If stack checking (@pxref{Stack Checking}) can be done on your system by
6043 probing the stack but without the need to actually access it, define this
6044 pattern and signal an error if the stack has overflowed. The single operand
6045 is the memory address in the stack that needs to be probed.
6047 @cindex @code{probe_stack} instruction pattern
6048 @item @samp{probe_stack}
6049 If stack checking (@pxref{Stack Checking}) can be done on your system by
6050 probing the stack but doing it with a ``store zero'' instruction is not valid
6051 or optimal, define this pattern to do the probing differently and signal an
6052 error if the stack has overflowed. The single operand is the memory reference
6053 in the stack that needs to be probed.
6055 @cindex @code{nonlocal_goto} instruction pattern
6056 @item @samp{nonlocal_goto}
6057 Emit code to generate a non-local goto, e.g., a jump from one function
6058 to a label in an outer function. This pattern has four arguments,
6059 each representing a value to be used in the jump. The first
6060 argument is to be loaded into the frame pointer, the second is
6061 the address to branch to (code to dispatch to the actual label),
6062 the third is the address of a location where the stack is saved,
6063 and the last is the address of the label, to be placed in the
6064 location for the incoming static chain.
6066 On most machines you need not define this pattern, since GCC will
6067 already generate the correct code, which is to load the frame pointer
6068 and static chain, restore the stack (using the
6069 @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal} pattern, if defined), and jump indirectly
6070 to the dispatcher. You need only define this pattern if this code will
6071 not work on your machine.
6073 @cindex @code{nonlocal_goto_receiver} instruction pattern
6074 @item @samp{nonlocal_goto_receiver}
6075 This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the target of a
6076 nonlocal goto after the code already generated by GCC@. You will not
6077 normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you might
6078 need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global table,
6079 must be restored when the frame pointer is restored. Note that a nonlocal
6080 goto only occurs within a unit-of-translation, so a global table pointer
6081 that is shared by all functions of a given module need not be restored.
6082 There are no arguments.
6084 @cindex @code{exception_receiver} instruction pattern
6085 @item @samp{exception_receiver}
6086 This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the site of an
6087 exception handler that isn't needed at the site of a nonlocal goto. You
6088 will not normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you
6089 might need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global
6090 table, must be restored after control flow is branched to the handler of
6091 an exception. There are no arguments.
6093 @cindex @code{builtin_setjmp_setup} instruction pattern
6094 @item @samp{builtin_setjmp_setup}
6095 This pattern, if defined, contains additional code needed to initialize
6096 the @code{jmp_buf}. You will not normally need to define this pattern.
6097 A typical reason why you might need this pattern is if some value, such
6098 as a pointer to a global table, must be restored. Though it is
6099 preferred that the pointer value be recalculated if possible (given the
6100 address of a label for instance). The single argument is a pointer to
6101 the @code{jmp_buf}. Note that the buffer is five words long and that
6102 the first three are normally used by the generic mechanism.
6104 @cindex @code{builtin_setjmp_receiver} instruction pattern
6105 @item @samp{builtin_setjmp_receiver}
6106 This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the site of a
6107 built-in setjmp that isn't needed at the site of a nonlocal goto. You
6108 will not normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you
6109 might need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global
6110 table, must be restored. It takes one argument, which is the label
6111 to which builtin_longjmp transferred control; this pattern may be emitted
6112 at a small offset from that label.
6114 @cindex @code{builtin_longjmp} instruction pattern
6115 @item @samp{builtin_longjmp}
6116 This pattern, if defined, performs the entire action of the longjmp.
6117 You will not normally need to define this pattern unless you also define
6118 @code{builtin_setjmp_setup}. The single argument is a pointer to the
6121 @cindex @code{eh_return} instruction pattern
6122 @item @samp{eh_return}
6123 This pattern, if defined, affects the way @code{__builtin_eh_return},
6124 and thence the call frame exception handling library routines, are
6125 built. It is intended to handle non-trivial actions needed along
6126 the abnormal return path.
6128 The address of the exception handler to which the function should return
6129 is passed as operand to this pattern. It will normally need to copied by
6130 the pattern to some special register or memory location.
6131 If the pattern needs to determine the location of the target call
6132 frame in order to do so, it may use @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX},
6133 if defined; it will have already been assigned.
6135 If this pattern is not defined, the default action will be to simply
6136 copy the return address to @code{EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX}. Either
6137 that macro or this pattern needs to be defined if call frame exception
6138 handling is to be used.
6140 @cindex @code{prologue} instruction pattern
6141 @anchor{prologue instruction pattern}
6142 @item @samp{prologue}
6143 This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for entry to a function. The function
6144 entry is responsible for setting up the stack frame, initializing the frame
6145 pointer register, saving callee saved registers, etc.
6147 Using a prologue pattern is generally preferred over defining
6148 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} to emit assembly code for the prologue.
6150 The @code{prologue} pattern is particularly useful for targets which perform
6151 instruction scheduling.
6153 @cindex @code{window_save} instruction pattern
6154 @anchor{window_save instruction pattern}
6155 @item @samp{window_save}
6156 This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for a register window save. It should
6157 be defined if the target machine has register windows but the window events
6158 are decoupled from calls to subroutines. The canonical example is the SPARC
6161 @cindex @code{epilogue} instruction pattern
6162 @anchor{epilogue instruction pattern}
6163 @item @samp{epilogue}
6164 This pattern emits RTL for exit from a function. The function
6165 exit is responsible for deallocating the stack frame, restoring callee saved
6166 registers and emitting the return instruction.
6168 Using an epilogue pattern is generally preferred over defining
6169 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to emit assembly code for the epilogue.
6171 The @code{epilogue} pattern is particularly useful for targets which perform
6172 instruction scheduling or which have delay slots for their return instruction.
6174 @cindex @code{sibcall_epilogue} instruction pattern
6175 @item @samp{sibcall_epilogue}
6176 This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for exit from a function without the final
6177 branch back to the calling function. This pattern will be emitted before any
6178 sibling call (aka tail call) sites.
6180 The @code{sibcall_epilogue} pattern must not clobber any arguments used for
6181 parameter passing or any stack slots for arguments passed to the current
6184 @cindex @code{trap} instruction pattern
6186 This pattern, if defined, signals an error, typically by causing some
6187 kind of signal to be raised. Among other places, it is used by the Java
6188 front end to signal `invalid array index' exceptions.
6190 @cindex @code{ctrap@var{MM}4} instruction pattern
6191 @item @samp{ctrap@var{MM}4}
6192 Conditional trap instruction. Operand 0 is a piece of RTL which
6193 performs a comparison, and operands 1 and 2 are the arms of the
6194 comparison. Operand 3 is the trap code, an integer.
6196 A typical @code{ctrap} pattern looks like
6199 (define_insn "ctrapsi4"
6200 [(trap_if (match_operator 0 "trap_operator"
6201 [(match_operand 1 "register_operand")
6202 (match_operand 2 "immediate_operand")])
6203 (match_operand 3 "const_int_operand" "i"))]
6208 @cindex @code{prefetch} instruction pattern
6209 @item @samp{prefetch}
6211 This pattern, if defined, emits code for a non-faulting data prefetch
6212 instruction. Operand 0 is the address of the memory to prefetch. Operand 1
6213 is a constant 1 if the prefetch is preparing for a write to the memory
6214 address, or a constant 0 otherwise. Operand 2 is the expected degree of
6215 temporal locality of the data and is a value between 0 and 3, inclusive; 0
6216 means that the data has no temporal locality, so it need not be left in the
6217 cache after the access; 3 means that the data has a high degree of temporal
6218 locality and should be left in all levels of cache possible; 1 and 2 mean,
6219 respectively, a low or moderate degree of temporal locality.
6221 Targets that do not support write prefetches or locality hints can ignore
6222 the values of operands 1 and 2.
6224 @cindex @code{blockage} instruction pattern
6225 @item @samp{blockage}
6227 This pattern defines a pseudo insn that prevents the instruction
6228 scheduler and other passes from moving instructions and using register
6229 equivalences across the boundary defined by the blockage insn.
6230 This needs to be an UNSPEC_VOLATILE pattern or a volatile ASM.
6232 @cindex @code{memory_barrier} instruction pattern
6233 @item @samp{memory_barrier}
6235 If the target memory model is not fully synchronous, then this pattern
6236 should be defined to an instruction that orders both loads and stores
6237 before the instruction with respect to loads and stores after the instruction.
6238 This pattern has no operands.
6240 @cindex @code{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6241 @item @samp{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}
6243 This pattern, if defined, emits code for an atomic compare-and-swap
6244 operation. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
6245 performed. Operand 2 is the ``old'' value to be compared against the
6246 current contents of the memory location. Operand 3 is the ``new'' value
6247 to store in the memory if the compare succeeds. Operand 0 is the result
6248 of the operation; it should contain the contents of the memory
6249 before the operation. If the compare succeeds, this should obviously be
6250 a copy of operand 2.
6252 This pattern must show that both operand 0 and operand 1 are modified.
6254 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
6255 memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
6256 operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
6257 after the atomic operation.
6259 For targets where the success or failure of the compare-and-swap
6260 operation is available via the status flags, it is possible to
6261 avoid a separate compare operation and issue the subsequent
6262 branch or store-flag operation immediately after the compare-and-swap.
6263 To this end, GCC will look for a @code{MODE_CC} set in the
6264 output of @code{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}; if the machine
6265 description includes such a set, the target should also define special
6266 @code{cbranchcc4} and/or @code{cstorecc4} instructions. GCC will then
6267 be able to take the destination of the @code{MODE_CC} set and pass it
6268 to the @code{cbranchcc4} or @code{cstorecc4} pattern as the first
6269 operand of the comparison (the second will be @code{(const_int 0)}).
6271 For targets where the operating system may provide support for this
6272 operation via library calls, the @code{sync_compare_and_swap_optab}
6273 may be initialized to a function with the same interface as the
6274 @code{__sync_val_compare_and_swap_@var{n}} built-in. If the entire
6275 set of @var{__sync} builtins are supported via library calls, the
6276 target can initialize all of the optabs at once with
6277 @code{init_sync_libfuncs}.
6278 For the purposes of C++11 @code{std::atomic::is_lock_free}, it is
6279 assumed that these library calls do @emph{not} use any kind of
6280 interruptable locking.
6282 @cindex @code{sync_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6283 @cindex @code{sync_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6284 @cindex @code{sync_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6285 @cindex @code{sync_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6286 @cindex @code{sync_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6287 @cindex @code{sync_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6288 @item @samp{sync_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_sub@var{mode}}
6289 @itemx @samp{sync_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_and@var{mode}}
6290 @itemx @samp{sync_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_nand@var{mode}}
6292 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory.
6293 Operand 0 is the memory on which the atomic operation is performed.
6294 Operand 1 is the second operand to the binary operator.
6296 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
6297 memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
6298 operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
6299 after the atomic operation.
6301 If these patterns are not defined, the operation will be constructed
6302 from a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
6304 @cindex @code{sync_old_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6305 @cindex @code{sync_old_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6306 @cindex @code{sync_old_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6307 @cindex @code{sync_old_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6308 @cindex @code{sync_old_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6309 @cindex @code{sync_old_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6310 @item @samp{sync_old_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_sub@var{mode}}
6311 @itemx @samp{sync_old_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_and@var{mode}}
6312 @itemx @samp{sync_old_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_nand@var{mode}}
6314 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory,
6315 and return the value that the memory contained before the operation.
6316 Operand 0 is the result value, operand 1 is the memory on which the
6317 atomic operation is performed, and operand 2 is the second operand
6318 to the binary operator.
6320 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
6321 memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
6322 operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
6323 after the atomic operation.
6325 If these patterns are not defined, the operation will be constructed
6326 from a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
6328 @cindex @code{sync_new_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6329 @cindex @code{sync_new_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6330 @cindex @code{sync_new_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6331 @cindex @code{sync_new_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6332 @cindex @code{sync_new_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6333 @cindex @code{sync_new_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6334 @item @samp{sync_new_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_sub@var{mode}}
6335 @itemx @samp{sync_new_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_and@var{mode}}
6336 @itemx @samp{sync_new_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_nand@var{mode}}
6338 These patterns are like their @code{sync_old_@var{op}} counterparts,
6339 except that they return the value that exists in the memory location
6340 after the operation, rather than before the operation.
6342 @cindex @code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6343 @item @samp{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}
6345 This pattern takes two forms, based on the capabilities of the target.
6346 In either case, operand 0 is the result of the operand, operand 1 is
6347 the memory on which the atomic operation is performed, and operand 2
6348 is the value to set in the lock.
6350 In the ideal case, this operation is an atomic exchange operation, in
6351 which the previous value in memory operand is copied into the result
6352 operand, and the value operand is stored in the memory operand.
6354 For less capable targets, any value operand that is not the constant 1
6355 should be rejected with @code{FAIL}. In this case the target may use
6356 an atomic test-and-set bit operation. The result operand should contain
6357 1 if the bit was previously set and 0 if the bit was previously clear.
6358 The true contents of the memory operand are implementation defined.
6360 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that the
6361 pattern as a whole acts as an acquire barrier, that is all memory
6362 operations after the pattern do not occur until the lock is acquired.
6364 If this pattern is not defined, the operation will be constructed from
6365 a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
6367 @cindex @code{sync_lock_release@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6368 @item @samp{sync_lock_release@var{mode}}
6370 This pattern, if defined, releases a lock set by
6371 @code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}. Operand 0 is the memory
6372 that contains the lock; operand 1 is the value to store in the lock.
6374 If the target doesn't implement full semantics for
6375 @code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}, any value operand which is not
6376 the constant 0 should be rejected with @code{FAIL}, and the true contents
6377 of the memory operand are implementation defined.
6379 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that the
6380 pattern as a whole acts as a release barrier, that is the lock is
6381 released only after all previous memory operations have completed.
6383 If this pattern is not defined, then a @code{memory_barrier} pattern
6384 will be emitted, followed by a store of the value to the memory operand.
6386 @cindex @code{atomic_compare_and_swap@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6387 @item @samp{atomic_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}
6388 This pattern, if defined, emits code for an atomic compare-and-swap
6389 operation with memory model semantics. Operand 2 is the memory on which
6390 the atomic operation is performed. Operand 0 is an output operand which
6391 is set to true or false based on whether the operation succeeded. Operand
6392 1 is an output operand which is set to the contents of the memory before
6393 the operation was attempted. Operand 3 is the value that is expected to
6394 be in memory. Operand 4 is the value to put in memory if the expected
6395 value is found there. Operand 5 is set to 1 if this compare and swap is to
6396 be treated as a weak operation. Operand 6 is the memory model to be used
6397 if the operation is a success. Operand 7 is the memory model to be used
6398 if the operation fails.
6400 If memory referred to in operand 2 contains the value in operand 3, then
6401 operand 4 is stored in memory pointed to by operand 2 and fencing based on
6402 the memory model in operand 6 is issued.
6404 If memory referred to in operand 2 does not contain the value in operand 3,
6405 then fencing based on the memory model in operand 7 is issued.
6407 If a target does not support weak compare-and-swap operations, or the port
6408 elects not to implement weak operations, the argument in operand 5 can be
6409 ignored. Note a strong implementation must be provided.
6411 If this pattern is not provided, the @code{__atomic_compare_exchange}
6412 built-in functions will utilize the legacy @code{sync_compare_and_swap}
6413 pattern with an @code{__ATOMIC_SEQ_CST} memory model.
6415 @cindex @code{atomic_load@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6416 @item @samp{atomic_load@var{mode}}
6417 This pattern implements an atomic load operation with memory model
6418 semantics. Operand 1 is the memory address being loaded from. Operand 0
6419 is the result of the load. Operand 2 is the memory model to be used for
6422 If not present, the @code{__atomic_load} built-in function will either
6423 resort to a normal load with memory barriers, or a compare-and-swap
6424 operation if a normal load would not be atomic.
6426 @cindex @code{atomic_store@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6427 @item @samp{atomic_store@var{mode}}
6428 This pattern implements an atomic store operation with memory model
6429 semantics. Operand 0 is the memory address being stored to. Operand 1
6430 is the value to be written. Operand 2 is the memory model to be used for
6433 If not present, the @code{__atomic_store} built-in function will attempt to
6434 perform a normal store and surround it with any required memory fences. If
6435 the store would not be atomic, then an @code{__atomic_exchange} is
6436 attempted with the result being ignored.
6438 @cindex @code{atomic_exchange@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6439 @item @samp{atomic_exchange@var{mode}}
6440 This pattern implements an atomic exchange operation with memory model
6441 semantics. Operand 1 is the memory location the operation is performed on.
6442 Operand 0 is an output operand which is set to the original value contained
6443 in the memory pointed to by operand 1. Operand 2 is the value to be
6444 stored. Operand 3 is the memory model to be used.
6446 If this pattern is not present, the built-in function
6447 @code{__atomic_exchange} will attempt to preform the operation with a
6448 compare and swap loop.
6450 @cindex @code{atomic_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6451 @cindex @code{atomic_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6452 @cindex @code{atomic_or@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6453 @cindex @code{atomic_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6454 @cindex @code{atomic_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6455 @cindex @code{atomic_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6456 @item @samp{atomic_add@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_sub@var{mode}}
6457 @itemx @samp{atomic_or@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_and@var{mode}}
6458 @itemx @samp{atomic_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_nand@var{mode}}
6460 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory with memory
6461 model semantics. Operand 0 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
6462 performed. Operand 1 is the second operand to the binary operator.
6463 Operand 2 is the memory model to be used by the operation.
6465 If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use legacy
6466 @code{sync} patterns, or equivalent patterns which return a result. If
6467 none of these are available a compare-and-swap loop will be used.
6469 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6470 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6471 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_or@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6472 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6473 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6474 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6475 @item @samp{atomic_fetch_add@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_fetch_sub@var{mode}}
6476 @itemx @samp{atomic_fetch_or@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_fetch_and@var{mode}}
6477 @itemx @samp{atomic_fetch_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_fetch_nand@var{mode}}
6479 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory with memory
6480 model semantics, and return the original value. Operand 0 is an output
6481 operand which contains the value of the memory location before the
6482 operation was performed. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic
6483 operation is performed. Operand 2 is the second operand to the binary
6484 operator. Operand 3 is the memory model to be used by the operation.
6486 If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use legacy
6487 @code{sync} patterns. If none of these are available a compare-and-swap
6490 @cindex @code{atomic_add_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6491 @cindex @code{atomic_sub_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6492 @cindex @code{atomic_or_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6493 @cindex @code{atomic_and_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6494 @cindex @code{atomic_xor_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6495 @cindex @code{atomic_nand_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6496 @item @samp{atomic_add_fetch@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_sub_fetch@var{mode}}
6497 @itemx @samp{atomic_or_fetch@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_and_fetch@var{mode}}
6498 @itemx @samp{atomic_xor_fetch@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_nand_fetch@var{mode}}
6500 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory with memory
6501 model semantics and return the result after the operation is performed.
6502 Operand 0 is an output operand which contains the value after the
6503 operation. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
6504 performed. Operand 2 is the second operand to the binary operator.
6505 Operand 3 is the memory model to be used by the operation.
6507 If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use legacy
6508 @code{sync} patterns, or equivalent patterns which return the result before
6509 the operation followed by the arithmetic operation required to produce the
6510 result. If none of these are available a compare-and-swap loop will be
6513 @cindex @code{atomic_test_and_set} instruction pattern
6514 @item @samp{atomic_test_and_set}
6516 This pattern emits code for @code{__builtin_atomic_test_and_set}.
6517 Operand 0 is an output operand which is set to true if the previous
6518 previous contents of the byte was "set", and false otherwise. Operand 1
6519 is the @code{QImode} memory to be modified. Operand 2 is the memory
6522 The specific value that defines "set" is implementation defined, and
6523 is normally based on what is performed by the native atomic test and set
6526 @cindex @code{mem_thread_fence@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6527 @item @samp{mem_thread_fence@var{mode}}
6528 This pattern emits code required to implement a thread fence with
6529 memory model semantics. Operand 0 is the memory model to be used.
6531 If this pattern is not specified, all memory models except
6532 @code{__ATOMIC_RELAXED} will result in issuing a @code{sync_synchronize}
6535 @cindex @code{mem_signal_fence@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6536 @item @samp{mem_signal_fence@var{mode}}
6537 This pattern emits code required to implement a signal fence with
6538 memory model semantics. Operand 0 is the memory model to be used.
6540 This pattern should impact the compiler optimizers the same way that
6541 mem_signal_fence does, but it does not need to issue any barrier
6544 If this pattern is not specified, all memory models except
6545 @code{__ATOMIC_RELAXED} will result in issuing a @code{sync_synchronize}
6548 @cindex @code{get_thread_pointer@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6549 @cindex @code{set_thread_pointer@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6550 @item @samp{get_thread_pointer@var{mode}}
6551 @itemx @samp{set_thread_pointer@var{mode}}
6552 These patterns emit code that reads/sets the TLS thread pointer. Currently,
6553 these are only needed if the target needs to support the
6554 @code{__builtin_thread_pointer} and @code{__builtin_set_thread_pointer}
6557 The get/set patterns have a single output/input operand respectively,
6558 with @var{mode} intended to be @code{Pmode}.
6560 @cindex @code{stack_protect_set} instruction pattern
6561 @item @samp{stack_protect_set}
6563 This pattern, if defined, moves a @code{ptr_mode} value from the memory
6564 in operand 1 to the memory in operand 0 without leaving the value in
6565 a register afterward. This is to avoid leaking the value some place
6566 that an attacker might use to rewrite the stack guard slot after
6567 having clobbered it.
6569 If this pattern is not defined, then a plain move pattern is generated.
6571 @cindex @code{stack_protect_test} instruction pattern
6572 @item @samp{stack_protect_test}
6574 This pattern, if defined, compares a @code{ptr_mode} value from the
6575 memory in operand 1 with the memory in operand 0 without leaving the
6576 value in a register afterward and branches to operand 2 if the values
6579 If this pattern is not defined, then a plain compare pattern and
6580 conditional branch pattern is used.
6582 @cindex @code{clear_cache} instruction pattern
6583 @item @samp{clear_cache}
6585 This pattern, if defined, flushes the instruction cache for a region of
6586 memory. The region is bounded to by the Pmode pointers in operand 0
6587 inclusive and operand 1 exclusive.
6589 If this pattern is not defined, a call to the library function
6590 @code{__clear_cache} is used.
6595 @c Each of the following nodes are wrapped in separate
6596 @c "@ifset INTERNALS" to work around memory limits for the default
6597 @c configuration in older tetex distributions. Known to not work:
6598 @c tetex-1.0.7, known to work: tetex-2.0.2.
6600 @node Pattern Ordering
6601 @section When the Order of Patterns Matters
6602 @cindex Pattern Ordering
6603 @cindex Ordering of Patterns
6605 Sometimes an insn can match more than one instruction pattern. Then the
6606 pattern that appears first in the machine description is the one used.
6607 Therefore, more specific patterns (patterns that will match fewer things)
6608 and faster instructions (those that will produce better code when they
6609 do match) should usually go first in the description.
6611 In some cases the effect of ordering the patterns can be used to hide
6612 a pattern when it is not valid. For example, the 68000 has an
6613 instruction for converting a fullword to floating point and another
6614 for converting a byte to floating point. An instruction converting
6615 an integer to floating point could match either one. We put the
6616 pattern to convert the fullword first to make sure that one will
6617 be used rather than the other. (Otherwise a large integer might
6618 be generated as a single-byte immediate quantity, which would not work.)
6619 Instead of using this pattern ordering it would be possible to make the
6620 pattern for convert-a-byte smart enough to deal properly with any
6625 @node Dependent Patterns
6626 @section Interdependence of Patterns
6627 @cindex Dependent Patterns
6628 @cindex Interdependence of Patterns
6630 In some cases machines support instructions identical except for the
6631 machine mode of one or more operands. For example, there may be
6632 ``sign-extend halfword'' and ``sign-extend byte'' instructions whose
6636 (set (match_operand:SI 0 @dots{})
6637 (extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 @dots{})))
6639 (set (match_operand:SI 0 @dots{})
6640 (extend:SI (match_operand:QI 1 @dots{})))
6644 Constant integers do not specify a machine mode, so an instruction to
6645 extend a constant value could match either pattern. The pattern it
6646 actually will match is the one that appears first in the file. For correct
6647 results, this must be the one for the widest possible mode (@code{HImode},
6648 here). If the pattern matches the @code{QImode} instruction, the results
6649 will be incorrect if the constant value does not actually fit that mode.
6651 Such instructions to extend constants are rarely generated because they are
6652 optimized away, but they do occasionally happen in nonoptimized
6655 If a constraint in a pattern allows a constant, the reload pass may
6656 replace a register with a constant permitted by the constraint in some
6657 cases. Similarly for memory references. Because of this substitution,
6658 you should not provide separate patterns for increment and decrement
6659 instructions. Instead, they should be generated from the same pattern
6660 that supports register-register add insns by examining the operands and
6661 generating the appropriate machine instruction.
6666 @section Defining Jump Instruction Patterns
6667 @cindex jump instruction patterns
6668 @cindex defining jump instruction patterns
6670 GCC does not assume anything about how the machine realizes jumps.
6671 The machine description should define a single pattern, usually
6672 a @code{define_expand}, which expands to all the required insns.
6674 Usually, this would be a comparison insn to set the condition code
6675 and a separate branch insn testing the condition code and branching
6676 or not according to its value. For many machines, however,
6677 separating compares and branches is limiting, which is why the
6678 more flexible approach with one @code{define_expand} is used in GCC.
6679 The machine description becomes clearer for architectures that
6680 have compare-and-branch instructions but no condition code. It also
6681 works better when different sets of comparison operators are supported
6682 by different kinds of conditional branches (e.g. integer vs. floating-point),
6683 or by conditional branches with respect to conditional stores.
6685 Two separate insns are always used if the machine description represents
6686 a condition code register using the legacy RTL expression @code{(cc0)},
6687 and on most machines that use a separate condition code register
6688 (@pxref{Condition Code}). For machines that use @code{(cc0)}, in
6689 fact, the set and use of the condition code must be separate and
6690 adjacent@footnote{@code{note} insns can separate them, though.}, thus
6691 allowing flags in @code{cc_status} to be used (@pxref{Condition Code}) and
6692 so that the comparison and branch insns could be located from each other
6693 by using the functions @code{prev_cc0_setter} and @code{next_cc0_user}.
6695 Even in this case having a single entry point for conditional branches
6696 is advantageous, because it handles equally well the case where a single
6697 comparison instruction records the results of both signed and unsigned
6698 comparison of the given operands (with the branch insns coming in distinct
6699 signed and unsigned flavors) as in the x86 or SPARC, and the case where
6700 there are distinct signed and unsigned compare instructions and only
6701 one set of conditional branch instructions as in the PowerPC.
6705 @node Looping Patterns
6706 @section Defining Looping Instruction Patterns
6707 @cindex looping instruction patterns
6708 @cindex defining looping instruction patterns
6710 Some machines have special jump instructions that can be utilized to
6711 make loops more efficient. A common example is the 68000 @samp{dbra}
6712 instruction which performs a decrement of a register and a branch if the
6713 result was greater than zero. Other machines, in particular digital
6714 signal processors (DSPs), have special block repeat instructions to
6715 provide low-overhead loop support. For example, the TI TMS320C3x/C4x
6716 DSPs have a block repeat instruction that loads special registers to
6717 mark the top and end of a loop and to count the number of loop
6718 iterations. This avoids the need for fetching and executing a
6719 @samp{dbra}-like instruction and avoids pipeline stalls associated with
6722 GCC has three special named patterns to support low overhead looping.
6723 They are @samp{decrement_and_branch_until_zero}, @samp{doloop_begin},
6724 and @samp{doloop_end}. The first pattern,
6725 @samp{decrement_and_branch_until_zero}, is not emitted during RTL
6726 generation but may be emitted during the instruction combination phase.
6727 This requires the assistance of the loop optimizer, using information
6728 collected during strength reduction, to reverse a loop to count down to
6729 zero. Some targets also require the loop optimizer to add a
6730 @code{REG_NONNEG} note to indicate that the iteration count is always
6731 positive. This is needed if the target performs a signed loop
6732 termination test. For example, the 68000 uses a pattern similar to the
6733 following for its @code{dbra} instruction:
6737 (define_insn "decrement_and_branch_until_zero"
6740 (ge (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "+d*am")
6743 (label_ref (match_operand 1 "" ""))
6746 (plus:SI (match_dup 0)
6748 "find_reg_note (insn, REG_NONNEG, 0)"
6753 Note that since the insn is both a jump insn and has an output, it must
6754 deal with its own reloads, hence the `m' constraints. Also note that
6755 since this insn is generated by the instruction combination phase
6756 combining two sequential insns together into an implicit parallel insn,
6757 the iteration counter needs to be biased by the same amount as the
6758 decrement operation, in this case @minus{}1. Note that the following similar
6759 pattern will not be matched by the combiner.
6763 (define_insn "decrement_and_branch_until_zero"
6766 (ge (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "+d*am")
6768 (label_ref (match_operand 1 "" ""))
6771 (plus:SI (match_dup 0)
6773 "find_reg_note (insn, REG_NONNEG, 0)"
6778 The other two special looping patterns, @samp{doloop_begin} and
6779 @samp{doloop_end}, are emitted by the loop optimizer for certain
6780 well-behaved loops with a finite number of loop iterations using
6781 information collected during strength reduction.
6783 The @samp{doloop_end} pattern describes the actual looping instruction
6784 (or the implicit looping operation) and the @samp{doloop_begin} pattern
6785 is an optional companion pattern that can be used for initialization
6786 needed for some low-overhead looping instructions.
6788 Note that some machines require the actual looping instruction to be
6789 emitted at the top of the loop (e.g., the TMS320C3x/C4x DSPs). Emitting
6790 the true RTL for a looping instruction at the top of the loop can cause
6791 problems with flow analysis. So instead, a dummy @code{doloop} insn is
6792 emitted at the end of the loop. The machine dependent reorg pass checks
6793 for the presence of this @code{doloop} insn and then searches back to
6794 the top of the loop, where it inserts the true looping insn (provided
6795 there are no instructions in the loop which would cause problems). Any
6796 additional labels can be emitted at this point. In addition, if the
6797 desired special iteration counter register was not allocated, this
6798 machine dependent reorg pass could emit a traditional compare and jump
6801 The essential difference between the
6802 @samp{decrement_and_branch_until_zero} and the @samp{doloop_end}
6803 patterns is that the loop optimizer allocates an additional pseudo
6804 register for the latter as an iteration counter. This pseudo register
6805 cannot be used within the loop (i.e., general induction variables cannot
6806 be derived from it), however, in many cases the loop induction variable
6807 may become redundant and removed by the flow pass.
6812 @node Insn Canonicalizations
6813 @section Canonicalization of Instructions
6814 @cindex canonicalization of instructions
6815 @cindex insn canonicalization
6817 There are often cases where multiple RTL expressions could represent an
6818 operation performed by a single machine instruction. This situation is
6819 most commonly encountered with logical, branch, and multiply-accumulate
6820 instructions. In such cases, the compiler attempts to convert these
6821 multiple RTL expressions into a single canonical form to reduce the
6822 number of insn patterns required.
6824 In addition to algebraic simplifications, following canonicalizations
6829 For commutative and comparison operators, a constant is always made the
6830 second operand. If a machine only supports a constant as the second
6831 operand, only patterns that match a constant in the second operand need
6835 For associative operators, a sequence of operators will always chain
6836 to the left; for instance, only the left operand of an integer @code{plus}
6837 can itself be a @code{plus}. @code{and}, @code{ior}, @code{xor},
6838 @code{plus}, @code{mult}, @code{smin}, @code{smax}, @code{umin}, and
6839 @code{umax} are associative when applied to integers, and sometimes to
6843 @cindex @code{neg}, canonicalization of
6844 @cindex @code{not}, canonicalization of
6845 @cindex @code{mult}, canonicalization of
6846 @cindex @code{plus}, canonicalization of
6847 @cindex @code{minus}, canonicalization of
6848 For these operators, if only one operand is a @code{neg}, @code{not},
6849 @code{mult}, @code{plus}, or @code{minus} expression, it will be the
6853 In combinations of @code{neg}, @code{mult}, @code{plus}, and
6854 @code{minus}, the @code{neg} operations (if any) will be moved inside
6855 the operations as far as possible. For instance,
6856 @code{(neg (mult A B))} is canonicalized as @code{(mult (neg A) B)}, but
6857 @code{(plus (mult (neg B) C) A)} is canonicalized as
6858 @code{(minus A (mult B C))}.
6860 @cindex @code{compare}, canonicalization of
6862 For the @code{compare} operator, a constant is always the second operand
6863 if the first argument is a condition code register or @code{(cc0)}.
6866 An operand of @code{neg}, @code{not}, @code{mult}, @code{plus}, or
6867 @code{minus} is made the first operand under the same conditions as
6871 @code{(ltu (plus @var{a} @var{b}) @var{b})} is converted to
6872 @code{(ltu (plus @var{a} @var{b}) @var{a})}. Likewise with @code{geu} instead
6876 @code{(minus @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))} is converted to
6877 @code{(plus @var{x} (const_int @var{-n}))}.
6880 Within address computations (i.e., inside @code{mem}), a left shift is
6881 converted into the appropriate multiplication by a power of two.
6883 @cindex @code{ior}, canonicalization of
6884 @cindex @code{and}, canonicalization of
6885 @cindex De Morgan's law
6887 De Morgan's Law is used to move bitwise negation inside a bitwise
6888 logical-and or logical-or operation. If this results in only one
6889 operand being a @code{not} expression, it will be the first one.
6891 A machine that has an instruction that performs a bitwise logical-and of one
6892 operand with the bitwise negation of the other should specify the pattern
6893 for that instruction as
6897 [(set (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{})
6898 (and:@var{m} (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 1 @dots{}))
6899 (match_operand:@var{m} 2 @dots{})))]
6905 Similarly, a pattern for a ``NAND'' instruction should be written
6909 [(set (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{})
6910 (ior:@var{m} (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 1 @dots{}))
6911 (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 2 @dots{}))))]
6916 In both cases, it is not necessary to include patterns for the many
6917 logically equivalent RTL expressions.
6919 @cindex @code{xor}, canonicalization of
6921 The only possible RTL expressions involving both bitwise exclusive-or
6922 and bitwise negation are @code{(xor:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y})}
6923 and @code{(not:@var{m} (xor:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y}))}.
6926 The sum of three items, one of which is a constant, will only appear in
6930 (plus:@var{m} (plus:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y}) @var{constant})
6933 @cindex @code{zero_extract}, canonicalization of
6934 @cindex @code{sign_extract}, canonicalization of
6936 Equality comparisons of a group of bits (usually a single bit) with zero
6937 will be written using @code{zero_extract} rather than the equivalent
6938 @code{and} or @code{sign_extract} operations.
6940 @cindex @code{mult}, canonicalization of
6942 @code{(sign_extend:@var{m1} (mult:@var{m2} (sign_extend:@var{m2} @var{x})
6943 (sign_extend:@var{m2} @var{y})))} is converted to @code{(mult:@var{m1}
6944 (sign_extend:@var{m1} @var{x}) (sign_extend:@var{m1} @var{y}))}, and likewise
6945 for @code{zero_extend}.
6948 @code{(sign_extend:@var{m1} (mult:@var{m2} (ashiftrt:@var{m2}
6949 @var{x} @var{s}) (sign_extend:@var{m2} @var{y})))} is converted
6950 to @code{(mult:@var{m1} (sign_extend:@var{m1} (ashiftrt:@var{m2}
6951 @var{x} @var{s})) (sign_extend:@var{m1} @var{y}))}, and likewise for
6952 patterns using @code{zero_extend} and @code{lshiftrt}. If the second
6953 operand of @code{mult} is also a shift, then that is extended also.
6954 This transformation is only applied when it can be proven that the
6955 original operation had sufficient precision to prevent overflow.
6959 Further canonicalization rules are defined in the function
6960 @code{commutative_operand_precedence} in @file{gcc/rtlanal.c}.
6964 @node Expander Definitions
6965 @section Defining RTL Sequences for Code Generation
6966 @cindex expander definitions
6967 @cindex code generation RTL sequences
6968 @cindex defining RTL sequences for code generation
6970 On some target machines, some standard pattern names for RTL generation
6971 cannot be handled with single insn, but a sequence of RTL insns can
6972 represent them. For these target machines, you can write a
6973 @code{define_expand} to specify how to generate the sequence of RTL@.
6975 @findex define_expand
6976 A @code{define_expand} is an RTL expression that looks almost like a
6977 @code{define_insn}; but, unlike the latter, a @code{define_expand} is used
6978 only for RTL generation and it can produce more than one RTL insn.
6980 A @code{define_expand} RTX has four operands:
6984 The name. Each @code{define_expand} must have a name, since the only
6985 use for it is to refer to it by name.
6988 The RTL template. This is a vector of RTL expressions representing
6989 a sequence of separate instructions. Unlike @code{define_insn}, there
6990 is no implicit surrounding @code{PARALLEL}.
6993 The condition, a string containing a C expression. This expression is
6994 used to express how the availability of this pattern depends on
6995 subclasses of target machine, selected by command-line options when GCC
6996 is run. This is just like the condition of a @code{define_insn} that
6997 has a standard name. Therefore, the condition (if present) may not
6998 depend on the data in the insn being matched, but only the
6999 target-machine-type flags. The compiler needs to test these conditions
7000 during initialization in order to learn exactly which named instructions
7001 are available in a particular run.
7004 The preparation statements, a string containing zero or more C
7005 statements which are to be executed before RTL code is generated from
7008 Usually these statements prepare temporary registers for use as
7009 internal operands in the RTL template, but they can also generate RTL
7010 insns directly by calling routines such as @code{emit_insn}, etc.
7011 Any such insns precede the ones that come from the RTL template.
7014 Optionally, a vector containing the values of attributes. @xref{Insn
7018 Every RTL insn emitted by a @code{define_expand} must match some
7019 @code{define_insn} in the machine description. Otherwise, the compiler
7020 will crash when trying to generate code for the insn or trying to optimize
7023 The RTL template, in addition to controlling generation of RTL insns,
7024 also describes the operands that need to be specified when this pattern
7025 is used. In particular, it gives a predicate for each operand.
7027 A true operand, which needs to be specified in order to generate RTL from
7028 the pattern, should be described with a @code{match_operand} in its first
7029 occurrence in the RTL template. This enters information on the operand's
7030 predicate into the tables that record such things. GCC uses the
7031 information to preload the operand into a register if that is required for
7032 valid RTL code. If the operand is referred to more than once, subsequent
7033 references should use @code{match_dup}.
7035 The RTL template may also refer to internal ``operands'' which are
7036 temporary registers or labels used only within the sequence made by the
7037 @code{define_expand}. Internal operands are substituted into the RTL
7038 template with @code{match_dup}, never with @code{match_operand}. The
7039 values of the internal operands are not passed in as arguments by the
7040 compiler when it requests use of this pattern. Instead, they are computed
7041 within the pattern, in the preparation statements. These statements
7042 compute the values and store them into the appropriate elements of
7043 @code{operands} so that @code{match_dup} can find them.
7045 There are two special macros defined for use in the preparation statements:
7046 @code{DONE} and @code{FAIL}. Use them with a following semicolon,
7053 Use the @code{DONE} macro to end RTL generation for the pattern. The
7054 only RTL insns resulting from the pattern on this occasion will be
7055 those already emitted by explicit calls to @code{emit_insn} within the
7056 preparation statements; the RTL template will not be generated.
7060 Make the pattern fail on this occasion. When a pattern fails, it means
7061 that the pattern was not truly available. The calling routines in the
7062 compiler will try other strategies for code generation using other patterns.
7064 Failure is currently supported only for binary (addition, multiplication,
7065 shifting, etc.) and bit-field (@code{extv}, @code{extzv}, and @code{insv})
7069 If the preparation falls through (invokes neither @code{DONE} nor
7070 @code{FAIL}), then the @code{define_expand} acts like a
7071 @code{define_insn} in that the RTL template is used to generate the
7074 The RTL template is not used for matching, only for generating the
7075 initial insn list. If the preparation statement always invokes
7076 @code{DONE} or @code{FAIL}, the RTL template may be reduced to a simple
7077 list of operands, such as this example:
7081 (define_expand "addsi3"
7082 [(match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
7083 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "")
7084 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "")]
7090 handle_add (operands[0], operands[1], operands[2]);
7096 Here is an example, the definition of left-shift for the SPUR chip:
7100 (define_expand "ashlsi3"
7101 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
7105 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "")
7106 (match_operand:SI 2 "nonmemory_operand" "")))]
7115 if (GET_CODE (operands[2]) != CONST_INT
7116 || (unsigned) INTVAL (operands[2]) > 3)
7123 This example uses @code{define_expand} so that it can generate an RTL insn
7124 for shifting when the shift-count is in the supported range of 0 to 3 but
7125 fail in other cases where machine insns aren't available. When it fails,
7126 the compiler tries another strategy using different patterns (such as, a
7129 If the compiler were able to handle nontrivial condition-strings in
7130 patterns with names, then it would be possible to use a
7131 @code{define_insn} in that case. Here is another case (zero-extension
7132 on the 68000) which makes more use of the power of @code{define_expand}:
7135 (define_expand "zero_extendhisi2"
7136 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "")
7138 (set (strict_low_part
7142 (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" ""))]
7144 "operands[1] = make_safe_from (operands[1], operands[0]);")
7148 @findex make_safe_from
7149 Here two RTL insns are generated, one to clear the entire output operand
7150 and the other to copy the input operand into its low half. This sequence
7151 is incorrect if the input operand refers to [the old value of] the output
7152 operand, so the preparation statement makes sure this isn't so. The
7153 function @code{make_safe_from} copies the @code{operands[1]} into a
7154 temporary register if it refers to @code{operands[0]}. It does this
7155 by emitting another RTL insn.
7157 Finally, a third example shows the use of an internal operand.
7158 Zero-extension on the SPUR chip is done by @code{and}-ing the result
7159 against a halfword mask. But this mask cannot be represented by a
7160 @code{const_int} because the constant value is too large to be legitimate
7161 on this machine. So it must be copied into a register with
7162 @code{force_reg} and then the register used in the @code{and}.
7165 (define_expand "zero_extendhisi2"
7166 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
7168 (match_operand:HI 1 "register_operand" "")
7173 = force_reg (SImode, GEN_INT (65535)); ")
7176 @emph{Note:} If the @code{define_expand} is used to serve a
7177 standard binary or unary arithmetic operation or a bit-field operation,
7178 then the last insn it generates must not be a @code{code_label},
7179 @code{barrier} or @code{note}. It must be an @code{insn},
7180 @code{jump_insn} or @code{call_insn}. If you don't need a real insn
7181 at the end, emit an insn to copy the result of the operation into
7182 itself. Such an insn will generate no code, but it can avoid problems
7187 @node Insn Splitting
7188 @section Defining How to Split Instructions
7189 @cindex insn splitting
7190 @cindex instruction splitting
7191 @cindex splitting instructions
7193 There are two cases where you should specify how to split a pattern
7194 into multiple insns. On machines that have instructions requiring
7195 delay slots (@pxref{Delay Slots}) or that have instructions whose
7196 output is not available for multiple cycles (@pxref{Processor pipeline
7197 description}), the compiler phases that optimize these cases need to
7198 be able to move insns into one-instruction delay slots. However, some
7199 insns may generate more than one machine instruction. These insns
7200 cannot be placed into a delay slot.
7202 Often you can rewrite the single insn as a list of individual insns,
7203 each corresponding to one machine instruction. The disadvantage of
7204 doing so is that it will cause the compilation to be slower and require
7205 more space. If the resulting insns are too complex, it may also
7206 suppress some optimizations. The compiler splits the insn if there is a
7207 reason to believe that it might improve instruction or delay slot
7210 The insn combiner phase also splits putative insns. If three insns are
7211 merged into one insn with a complex expression that cannot be matched by
7212 some @code{define_insn} pattern, the combiner phase attempts to split
7213 the complex pattern into two insns that are recognized. Usually it can
7214 break the complex pattern into two patterns by splitting out some
7215 subexpression. However, in some other cases, such as performing an
7216 addition of a large constant in two insns on a RISC machine, the way to
7217 split the addition into two insns is machine-dependent.
7219 @findex define_split
7220 The @code{define_split} definition tells the compiler how to split a
7221 complex insn into several simpler insns. It looks like this:
7225 [@var{insn-pattern}]
7227 [@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
7228 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}
7230 "@var{preparation-statements}")
7233 @var{insn-pattern} is a pattern that needs to be split and
7234 @var{condition} is the final condition to be tested, as in a
7235 @code{define_insn}. When an insn matching @var{insn-pattern} and
7236 satisfying @var{condition} is found, it is replaced in the insn list
7237 with the insns given by @var{new-insn-pattern-1},
7238 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}, etc.
7240 The @var{preparation-statements} are similar to those statements that
7241 are specified for @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions})
7242 and are executed before the new RTL is generated to prepare for the
7243 generated code or emit some insns whose pattern is not fixed. Unlike
7244 those in @code{define_expand}, however, these statements must not
7245 generate any new pseudo-registers. Once reload has completed, they also
7246 must not allocate any space in the stack frame.
7248 Patterns are matched against @var{insn-pattern} in two different
7249 circumstances. If an insn needs to be split for delay slot scheduling
7250 or insn scheduling, the insn is already known to be valid, which means
7251 that it must have been matched by some @code{define_insn} and, if
7252 @code{reload_completed} is nonzero, is known to satisfy the constraints
7253 of that @code{define_insn}. In that case, the new insn patterns must
7254 also be insns that are matched by some @code{define_insn} and, if
7255 @code{reload_completed} is nonzero, must also satisfy the constraints
7256 of those definitions.
7258 As an example of this usage of @code{define_split}, consider the following
7259 example from @file{a29k.md}, which splits a @code{sign_extend} from
7260 @code{HImode} to @code{SImode} into a pair of shift insns:
7264 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "gen_reg_operand" "")
7265 (sign_extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")))]
7268 (ashift:SI (match_dup 1)
7271 (ashiftrt:SI (match_dup 0)
7274 @{ operands[1] = gen_lowpart (SImode, operands[1]); @}")
7277 When the combiner phase tries to split an insn pattern, it is always the
7278 case that the pattern is @emph{not} matched by any @code{define_insn}.
7279 The combiner pass first tries to split a single @code{set} expression
7280 and then the same @code{set} expression inside a @code{parallel}, but
7281 followed by a @code{clobber} of a pseudo-reg to use as a scratch
7282 register. In these cases, the combiner expects exactly two new insn
7283 patterns to be generated. It will verify that these patterns match some
7284 @code{define_insn} definitions, so you need not do this test in the
7285 @code{define_split} (of course, there is no point in writing a
7286 @code{define_split} that will never produce insns that match).
7288 Here is an example of this use of @code{define_split}, taken from
7293 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "gen_reg_operand" "")
7294 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")
7295 (match_operand:SI 2 "non_add_cint_operand" "")))]
7297 [(set (match_dup 0) (plus:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 3)))
7298 (set (match_dup 0) (plus:SI (match_dup 0) (match_dup 4)))]
7301 int low = INTVAL (operands[2]) & 0xffff;
7302 int high = (unsigned) INTVAL (operands[2]) >> 16;
7305 high++, low |= 0xffff0000;
7307 operands[3] = GEN_INT (high << 16);
7308 operands[4] = GEN_INT (low);
7312 Here the predicate @code{non_add_cint_operand} matches any
7313 @code{const_int} that is @emph{not} a valid operand of a single add
7314 insn. The add with the smaller displacement is written so that it
7315 can be substituted into the address of a subsequent operation.
7317 An example that uses a scratch register, from the same file, generates
7318 an equality comparison of a register and a large constant:
7322 [(set (match_operand:CC 0 "cc_reg_operand" "")
7323 (compare:CC (match_operand:SI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")
7324 (match_operand:SI 2 "non_short_cint_operand" "")))
7325 (clobber (match_operand:SI 3 "gen_reg_operand" ""))]
7326 "find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)
7327 && (GET_CODE (*find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)) == EQ
7328 || GET_CODE (*find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)) == NE)"
7329 [(set (match_dup 3) (xor:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 4)))
7330 (set (match_dup 0) (compare:CC (match_dup 3) (match_dup 5)))]
7333 /* @r{Get the constant we are comparing against, C, and see what it
7334 looks like sign-extended to 16 bits. Then see what constant
7335 could be XOR'ed with C to get the sign-extended value.} */
7337 int c = INTVAL (operands[2]);
7338 int sextc = (c << 16) >> 16;
7339 int xorv = c ^ sextc;
7341 operands[4] = GEN_INT (xorv);
7342 operands[5] = GEN_INT (sextc);
7346 To avoid confusion, don't write a single @code{define_split} that
7347 accepts some insns that match some @code{define_insn} as well as some
7348 insns that don't. Instead, write two separate @code{define_split}
7349 definitions, one for the insns that are valid and one for the insns that
7352 The splitter is allowed to split jump instructions into sequence of
7353 jumps or create new jumps in while splitting non-jump instructions. As
7354 the central flowgraph and branch prediction information needs to be updated,
7355 several restriction apply.
7357 Splitting of jump instruction into sequence that over by another jump
7358 instruction is always valid, as compiler expect identical behavior of new
7359 jump. When new sequence contains multiple jump instructions or new labels,
7360 more assistance is needed. Splitter is required to create only unconditional
7361 jumps, or simple conditional jump instructions. Additionally it must attach a
7362 @code{REG_BR_PROB} note to each conditional jump. A global variable
7363 @code{split_branch_probability} holds the probability of the original branch in case
7364 it was a simple conditional jump, @minus{}1 otherwise. To simplify
7365 recomputing of edge frequencies, the new sequence is required to have only
7366 forward jumps to the newly created labels.
7368 @findex define_insn_and_split
7369 For the common case where the pattern of a define_split exactly matches the
7370 pattern of a define_insn, use @code{define_insn_and_split}. It looks like
7374 (define_insn_and_split
7375 [@var{insn-pattern}]
7377 "@var{output-template}"
7378 "@var{split-condition}"
7379 [@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
7380 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}
7382 "@var{preparation-statements}"
7383 [@var{insn-attributes}])
7387 @var{insn-pattern}, @var{condition}, @var{output-template}, and
7388 @var{insn-attributes} are used as in @code{define_insn}. The
7389 @var{new-insn-pattern} vector and the @var{preparation-statements} are used as
7390 in a @code{define_split}. The @var{split-condition} is also used as in
7391 @code{define_split}, with the additional behavior that if the condition starts
7392 with @samp{&&}, the condition used for the split will be the constructed as a
7393 logical ``and'' of the split condition with the insn condition. For example,
7397 (define_insn_and_split "zero_extendhisi2_and"
7398 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
7399 (zero_extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 "register_operand" "0")))
7400 (clobber (reg:CC 17))]
7401 "TARGET_ZERO_EXTEND_WITH_AND && !optimize_size"
7403 "&& reload_completed"
7404 [(parallel [(set (match_dup 0)
7405 (and:SI (match_dup 0) (const_int 65535)))
7406 (clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
7408 [(set_attr "type" "alu1")])
7412 In this case, the actual split condition will be
7413 @samp{TARGET_ZERO_EXTEND_WITH_AND && !optimize_size && reload_completed}.
7415 The @code{define_insn_and_split} construction provides exactly the same
7416 functionality as two separate @code{define_insn} and @code{define_split}
7417 patterns. It exists for compactness, and as a maintenance tool to prevent
7418 having to ensure the two patterns' templates match.
7422 @node Including Patterns
7423 @section Including Patterns in Machine Descriptions.
7424 @cindex insn includes
7427 The @code{include} pattern tells the compiler tools where to
7428 look for patterns that are in files other than in the file
7429 @file{.md}. This is used only at build time and there is no preprocessing allowed.
7443 (include "filestuff")
7447 Where @var{pathname} is a string that specifies the location of the file,
7448 specifies the include file to be in @file{gcc/config/target/filestuff}. The
7449 directory @file{gcc/config/target} is regarded as the default directory.
7452 Machine descriptions may be split up into smaller more manageable subsections
7453 and placed into subdirectories.
7459 (include "BOGUS/filestuff")
7463 the include file is specified to be in @file{gcc/config/@var{target}/BOGUS/filestuff}.
7465 Specifying an absolute path for the include file such as;
7468 (include "/u2/BOGUS/filestuff")
7471 is permitted but is not encouraged.
7473 @subsection RTL Generation Tool Options for Directory Search
7474 @cindex directory options .md
7475 @cindex options, directory search
7476 @cindex search options
7478 The @option{-I@var{dir}} option specifies directories to search for machine descriptions.
7483 genrecog -I/p1/abc/proc1 -I/p2/abcd/pro2 target.md
7488 Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
7489 searched for header files. This can be used to override a system machine definition
7490 file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
7491 searched before the default machine description file directories. If you use more than
7492 one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
7493 order; the standard default directory come after.
7498 @node Peephole Definitions
7499 @section Machine-Specific Peephole Optimizers
7500 @cindex peephole optimizer definitions
7501 @cindex defining peephole optimizers
7503 In addition to instruction patterns the @file{md} file may contain
7504 definitions of machine-specific peephole optimizations.
7506 The combiner does not notice certain peephole optimizations when the data
7507 flow in the program does not suggest that it should try them. For example,
7508 sometimes two consecutive insns related in purpose can be combined even
7509 though the second one does not appear to use a register computed in the
7510 first one. A machine-specific peephole optimizer can detect such
7513 There are two forms of peephole definitions that may be used. The
7514 original @code{define_peephole} is run at assembly output time to
7515 match insns and substitute assembly text. Use of @code{define_peephole}
7518 A newer @code{define_peephole2} matches insns and substitutes new
7519 insns. The @code{peephole2} pass is run after register allocation
7520 but before scheduling, which may result in much better code for
7521 targets that do scheduling.
7524 * define_peephole:: RTL to Text Peephole Optimizers
7525 * define_peephole2:: RTL to RTL Peephole Optimizers
7530 @node define_peephole
7531 @subsection RTL to Text Peephole Optimizers
7532 @findex define_peephole
7535 A definition looks like this:
7539 [@var{insn-pattern-1}
7540 @var{insn-pattern-2}
7544 "@var{optional-insn-attributes}")
7548 The last string operand may be omitted if you are not using any
7549 machine-specific information in this machine description. If present,
7550 it must obey the same rules as in a @code{define_insn}.
7552 In this skeleton, @var{insn-pattern-1} and so on are patterns to match
7553 consecutive insns. The optimization applies to a sequence of insns when
7554 @var{insn-pattern-1} matches the first one, @var{insn-pattern-2} matches
7555 the next, and so on.
7557 Each of the insns matched by a peephole must also match a
7558 @code{define_insn}. Peepholes are checked only at the last stage just
7559 before code generation, and only optionally. Therefore, any insn which
7560 would match a peephole but no @code{define_insn} will cause a crash in code
7561 generation in an unoptimized compilation, or at various optimization
7564 The operands of the insns are matched with @code{match_operands},
7565 @code{match_operator}, and @code{match_dup}, as usual. What is not
7566 usual is that the operand numbers apply to all the insn patterns in the
7567 definition. So, you can check for identical operands in two insns by
7568 using @code{match_operand} in one insn and @code{match_dup} in the
7571 The operand constraints used in @code{match_operand} patterns do not have
7572 any direct effect on the applicability of the peephole, but they will
7573 be validated afterward, so make sure your constraints are general enough
7574 to apply whenever the peephole matches. If the peephole matches
7575 but the constraints are not satisfied, the compiler will crash.
7577 It is safe to omit constraints in all the operands of the peephole; or
7578 you can write constraints which serve as a double-check on the criteria
7581 Once a sequence of insns matches the patterns, the @var{condition} is
7582 checked. This is a C expression which makes the final decision whether to
7583 perform the optimization (we do so if the expression is nonzero). If
7584 @var{condition} is omitted (in other words, the string is empty) then the
7585 optimization is applied to every sequence of insns that matches the
7588 The defined peephole optimizations are applied after register allocation
7589 is complete. Therefore, the peephole definition can check which
7590 operands have ended up in which kinds of registers, just by looking at
7593 @findex prev_active_insn
7594 The way to refer to the operands in @var{condition} is to write
7595 @code{operands[@var{i}]} for operand number @var{i} (as matched by
7596 @code{(match_operand @var{i} @dots{})}). Use the variable @code{insn}
7597 to refer to the last of the insns being matched; use
7598 @code{prev_active_insn} to find the preceding insns.
7600 @findex dead_or_set_p
7601 When optimizing computations with intermediate results, you can use
7602 @var{condition} to match only when the intermediate results are not used
7603 elsewhere. Use the C expression @code{dead_or_set_p (@var{insn},
7604 @var{op})}, where @var{insn} is the insn in which you expect the value
7605 to be used for the last time (from the value of @code{insn}, together
7606 with use of @code{prev_nonnote_insn}), and @var{op} is the intermediate
7607 value (from @code{operands[@var{i}]}).
7609 Applying the optimization means replacing the sequence of insns with one
7610 new insn. The @var{template} controls ultimate output of assembler code
7611 for this combined insn. It works exactly like the template of a
7612 @code{define_insn}. Operand numbers in this template are the same ones
7613 used in matching the original sequence of insns.
7615 The result of a defined peephole optimizer does not need to match any of
7616 the insn patterns in the machine description; it does not even have an
7617 opportunity to match them. The peephole optimizer definition itself serves
7618 as the insn pattern to control how the insn is output.
7620 Defined peephole optimizers are run as assembler code is being output,
7621 so the insns they produce are never combined or rearranged in any way.
7623 Here is an example, taken from the 68000 machine description:
7627 [(set (reg:SI 15) (plus:SI (reg:SI 15) (const_int 4)))
7628 (set (match_operand:DF 0 "register_operand" "=f")
7629 (match_operand:DF 1 "register_operand" "ad"))]
7630 "FP_REG_P (operands[0]) && ! FP_REG_P (operands[1])"
7633 xoperands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[1]) + 1);
7635 output_asm_insn ("move.l %1,(sp)", xoperands);
7636 output_asm_insn ("move.l %1,-(sp)", operands);
7637 return "fmove.d (sp)+,%0";
7639 output_asm_insn ("movel %1,sp@@", xoperands);
7640 output_asm_insn ("movel %1,sp@@-", operands);
7641 return "fmoved sp@@+,%0";
7647 The effect of this optimization is to change
7673 If a peephole matches a sequence including one or more jump insns, you must
7674 take account of the flags such as @code{CC_REVERSED} which specify that the
7675 condition codes are represented in an unusual manner. The compiler
7676 automatically alters any ordinary conditional jumps which occur in such
7677 situations, but the compiler cannot alter jumps which have been replaced by
7678 peephole optimizations. So it is up to you to alter the assembler code
7679 that the peephole produces. Supply C code to write the assembler output,
7680 and in this C code check the condition code status flags and change the
7681 assembler code as appropriate.
7684 @var{insn-pattern-1} and so on look @emph{almost} like the second
7685 operand of @code{define_insn}. There is one important difference: the
7686 second operand of @code{define_insn} consists of one or more RTX's
7687 enclosed in square brackets. Usually, there is only one: then the same
7688 action can be written as an element of a @code{define_peephole}. But
7689 when there are multiple actions in a @code{define_insn}, they are
7690 implicitly enclosed in a @code{parallel}. Then you must explicitly
7691 write the @code{parallel}, and the square brackets within it, in the
7692 @code{define_peephole}. Thus, if an insn pattern looks like this,
7695 (define_insn "divmodsi4"
7696 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=d")
7697 (div:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
7698 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dmsK")))
7699 (set (match_operand:SI 3 "general_operand" "=d")
7700 (mod:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))]
7702 "divsl%.l %2,%3:%0")
7706 then the way to mention this insn in a peephole is as follows:
7712 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=d")
7713 (div:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
7714 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dmsK")))
7715 (set (match_operand:SI 3 "general_operand" "=d")
7716 (mod:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))])
7723 @node define_peephole2
7724 @subsection RTL to RTL Peephole Optimizers
7725 @findex define_peephole2
7727 The @code{define_peephole2} definition tells the compiler how to
7728 substitute one sequence of instructions for another sequence,
7729 what additional scratch registers may be needed and what their
7734 [@var{insn-pattern-1}
7735 @var{insn-pattern-2}
7738 [@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
7739 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}
7741 "@var{preparation-statements}")
7744 The definition is almost identical to @code{define_split}
7745 (@pxref{Insn Splitting}) except that the pattern to match is not a
7746 single instruction, but a sequence of instructions.
7748 It is possible to request additional scratch registers for use in the
7749 output template. If appropriate registers are not free, the pattern
7750 will simply not match.
7752 @findex match_scratch
7754 Scratch registers are requested with a @code{match_scratch} pattern at
7755 the top level of the input pattern. The allocated register (initially) will
7756 be dead at the point requested within the original sequence. If the scratch
7757 is used at more than a single point, a @code{match_dup} pattern at the
7758 top level of the input pattern marks the last position in the input sequence
7759 at which the register must be available.
7761 Here is an example from the IA-32 machine description:
7765 [(match_scratch:SI 2 "r")
7766 (parallel [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
7767 (match_operator:SI 3 "arith_or_logical_operator"
7769 (match_operand:SI 1 "memory_operand" "")]))
7770 (clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
7771 "! optimize_size && ! TARGET_READ_MODIFY"
7772 [(set (match_dup 2) (match_dup 1))
7773 (parallel [(set (match_dup 0)
7774 (match_op_dup 3 [(match_dup 0) (match_dup 2)]))
7775 (clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
7780 This pattern tries to split a load from its use in the hopes that we'll be
7781 able to schedule around the memory load latency. It allocates a single
7782 @code{SImode} register of class @code{GENERAL_REGS} (@code{"r"}) that needs
7783 to be live only at the point just before the arithmetic.
7785 A real example requiring extended scratch lifetimes is harder to come by,
7786 so here's a silly made-up example:
7790 [(match_scratch:SI 4 "r")
7791 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "" "") (match_operand:SI 1 "" ""))
7792 (set (match_operand:SI 2 "" "") (match_dup 1))
7794 (set (match_operand:SI 3 "" "") (match_dup 1))]
7795 "/* @r{determine 1 does not overlap 0 and 2} */"
7796 [(set (match_dup 4) (match_dup 1))
7797 (set (match_dup 0) (match_dup 4))
7798 (set (match_dup 2) (match_dup 4))
7799 (set (match_dup 3) (match_dup 4))]
7804 If we had not added the @code{(match_dup 4)} in the middle of the input
7805 sequence, it might have been the case that the register we chose at the
7806 beginning of the sequence is killed by the first or second @code{set}.
7810 @node Insn Attributes
7811 @section Instruction Attributes
7812 @cindex insn attributes
7813 @cindex instruction attributes
7815 In addition to describing the instruction supported by the target machine,
7816 the @file{md} file also defines a group of @dfn{attributes} and a set of
7817 values for each. Every generated insn is assigned a value for each attribute.
7818 One possible attribute would be the effect that the insn has on the machine's
7819 condition code. This attribute can then be used by @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}
7820 to track the condition codes.
7823 * Defining Attributes:: Specifying attributes and their values.
7824 * Expressions:: Valid expressions for attribute values.
7825 * Tagging Insns:: Assigning attribute values to insns.
7826 * Attr Example:: An example of assigning attributes.
7827 * Insn Lengths:: Computing the length of insns.
7828 * Constant Attributes:: Defining attributes that are constant.
7829 * Mnemonic Attribute:: Obtain the instruction mnemonic as attribute value.
7830 * Delay Slots:: Defining delay slots required for a machine.
7831 * Processor pipeline description:: Specifying information for insn scheduling.
7836 @node Defining Attributes
7837 @subsection Defining Attributes and their Values
7838 @cindex defining attributes and their values
7839 @cindex attributes, defining
7842 The @code{define_attr} expression is used to define each attribute required
7843 by the target machine. It looks like:
7846 (define_attr @var{name} @var{list-of-values} @var{default})
7849 @var{name} is a string specifying the name of the attribute being
7850 defined. Some attributes are used in a special way by the rest of the
7851 compiler. The @code{enabled} attribute can be used to conditionally
7852 enable or disable insn alternatives (@pxref{Disable Insn
7853 Alternatives}). The @code{predicable} attribute, together with a
7854 suitable @code{define_cond_exec} (@pxref{Conditional Execution}), can
7855 be used to automatically generate conditional variants of instruction
7856 patterns. The @code{mnemonic} attribute can be used to check for the
7857 instruction mnemonic (@pxref{Mnemonic Attribute}). The compiler
7858 internally uses the names @code{ce_enabled} and @code{nonce_enabled},
7859 so they should not be used elsewhere as alternative names.
7861 @var{list-of-values} is either a string that specifies a comma-separated
7862 list of values that can be assigned to the attribute, or a null string to
7863 indicate that the attribute takes numeric values.
7865 @var{default} is an attribute expression that gives the value of this
7866 attribute for insns that match patterns whose definition does not include
7867 an explicit value for this attribute. @xref{Attr Example}, for more
7868 information on the handling of defaults. @xref{Constant Attributes},
7869 for information on attributes that do not depend on any particular insn.
7872 For each defined attribute, a number of definitions are written to the
7873 @file{insn-attr.h} file. For cases where an explicit set of values is
7874 specified for an attribute, the following are defined:
7878 A @samp{#define} is written for the symbol @samp{HAVE_ATTR_@var{name}}.
7881 An enumerated class is defined for @samp{attr_@var{name}} with
7882 elements of the form @samp{@var{upper-name}_@var{upper-value}} where
7883 the attribute name and value are first converted to uppercase.
7886 A function @samp{get_attr_@var{name}} is defined that is passed an insn and
7887 returns the attribute value for that insn.
7890 For example, if the following is present in the @file{md} file:
7893 (define_attr "type" "branch,fp,load,store,arith" @dots{})
7897 the following lines will be written to the file @file{insn-attr.h}.
7900 #define HAVE_ATTR_type 1
7901 enum attr_type @{TYPE_BRANCH, TYPE_FP, TYPE_LOAD,
7902 TYPE_STORE, TYPE_ARITH@};
7903 extern enum attr_type get_attr_type ();
7906 If the attribute takes numeric values, no @code{enum} type will be
7907 defined and the function to obtain the attribute's value will return
7910 There are attributes which are tied to a specific meaning. These
7911 attributes are not free to use for other purposes:
7915 The @code{length} attribute is used to calculate the length of emitted
7916 code chunks. This is especially important when verifying branch
7917 distances. @xref{Insn Lengths}.
7920 The @code{enabled} attribute can be defined to prevent certain
7921 alternatives of an insn definition from being used during code
7922 generation. @xref{Disable Insn Alternatives}.
7925 The @code{mnemonic} attribute can be defined to implement instruction
7926 specific checks in e.g. the pipeline description.
7927 @xref{Mnemonic Attribute}.
7930 For each of these special attributes, the corresponding
7931 @samp{HAVE_ATTR_@var{name}} @samp{#define} is also written when the
7932 attribute is not defined; in that case, it is defined as @samp{0}.
7934 @findex define_enum_attr
7935 @anchor{define_enum_attr}
7936 Another way of defining an attribute is to use:
7939 (define_enum_attr "@var{attr}" "@var{enum}" @var{default})
7942 This works in just the same way as @code{define_attr}, except that
7943 the list of values is taken from a separate enumeration called
7944 @var{enum} (@pxref{define_enum}). This form allows you to use
7945 the same list of values for several attributes without having to
7946 repeat the list each time. For example:
7949 (define_enum "processor" [
7954 (define_enum_attr "arch" "processor"
7955 (const (symbol_ref "target_arch")))
7956 (define_enum_attr "tune" "processor"
7957 (const (symbol_ref "target_tune")))
7960 defines the same attributes as:
7963 (define_attr "arch" "model_a,model_b,@dots{}"
7964 (const (symbol_ref "target_arch")))
7965 (define_attr "tune" "model_a,model_b,@dots{}"
7966 (const (symbol_ref "target_tune")))
7969 but without duplicating the processor list. The second example defines two
7970 separate C enums (@code{attr_arch} and @code{attr_tune}) whereas the first
7971 defines a single C enum (@code{processor}).
7975 @subsection Attribute Expressions
7976 @cindex attribute expressions
7978 RTL expressions used to define attributes use the codes described above
7979 plus a few specific to attribute definitions, to be discussed below.
7980 Attribute value expressions must have one of the following forms:
7983 @cindex @code{const_int} and attributes
7984 @item (const_int @var{i})
7985 The integer @var{i} specifies the value of a numeric attribute. @var{i}
7986 must be non-negative.
7988 The value of a numeric attribute can be specified either with a
7989 @code{const_int}, or as an integer represented as a string in
7990 @code{const_string}, @code{eq_attr} (see below), @code{attr},
7991 @code{symbol_ref}, simple arithmetic expressions, and @code{set_attr}
7992 overrides on specific instructions (@pxref{Tagging Insns}).
7994 @cindex @code{const_string} and attributes
7995 @item (const_string @var{value})
7996 The string @var{value} specifies a constant attribute value.
7997 If @var{value} is specified as @samp{"*"}, it means that the default value of
7998 the attribute is to be used for the insn containing this expression.
7999 @samp{"*"} obviously cannot be used in the @var{default} expression
8000 of a @code{define_attr}.
8002 If the attribute whose value is being specified is numeric, @var{value}
8003 must be a string containing a non-negative integer (normally
8004 @code{const_int} would be used in this case). Otherwise, it must
8005 contain one of the valid values for the attribute.
8007 @cindex @code{if_then_else} and attributes
8008 @item (if_then_else @var{test} @var{true-value} @var{false-value})
8009 @var{test} specifies an attribute test, whose format is defined below.
8010 The value of this expression is @var{true-value} if @var{test} is true,
8011 otherwise it is @var{false-value}.
8013 @cindex @code{cond} and attributes
8014 @item (cond [@var{test1} @var{value1} @dots{}] @var{default})
8015 The first operand of this expression is a vector containing an even
8016 number of expressions and consisting of pairs of @var{test} and @var{value}
8017 expressions. The value of the @code{cond} expression is that of the
8018 @var{value} corresponding to the first true @var{test} expression. If
8019 none of the @var{test} expressions are true, the value of the @code{cond}
8020 expression is that of the @var{default} expression.
8023 @var{test} expressions can have one of the following forms:
8026 @cindex @code{const_int} and attribute tests
8027 @item (const_int @var{i})
8028 This test is true if @var{i} is nonzero and false otherwise.
8030 @cindex @code{not} and attributes
8031 @cindex @code{ior} and attributes
8032 @cindex @code{and} and attributes
8033 @item (not @var{test})
8034 @itemx (ior @var{test1} @var{test2})
8035 @itemx (and @var{test1} @var{test2})
8036 These tests are true if the indicated logical function is true.
8038 @cindex @code{match_operand} and attributes
8039 @item (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} @var{pred} @var{constraints})
8040 This test is true if operand @var{n} of the insn whose attribute value
8041 is being determined has mode @var{m} (this part of the test is ignored
8042 if @var{m} is @code{VOIDmode}) and the function specified by the string
8043 @var{pred} returns a nonzero value when passed operand @var{n} and mode
8044 @var{m} (this part of the test is ignored if @var{pred} is the null
8047 The @var{constraints} operand is ignored and should be the null string.
8049 @cindex @code{match_test} and attributes
8050 @item (match_test @var{c-expr})
8051 The test is true if C expression @var{c-expr} is true. In non-constant
8052 attributes, @var{c-expr} has access to the following variables:
8056 The rtl instruction under test.
8057 @item which_alternative
8058 The @code{define_insn} alternative that @var{insn} matches.
8059 @xref{Output Statement}.
8061 An array of @var{insn}'s rtl operands.
8064 @var{c-expr} behaves like the condition in a C @code{if} statement,
8065 so there is no need to explicitly convert the expression into a boolean
8066 0 or 1 value. For example, the following two tests are equivalent:
8069 (match_test "x & 2")
8070 (match_test "(x & 2) != 0")
8073 @cindex @code{le} and attributes
8074 @cindex @code{leu} and attributes
8075 @cindex @code{lt} and attributes
8076 @cindex @code{gt} and attributes
8077 @cindex @code{gtu} and attributes
8078 @cindex @code{ge} and attributes
8079 @cindex @code{geu} and attributes
8080 @cindex @code{ne} and attributes
8081 @cindex @code{eq} and attributes
8082 @cindex @code{plus} and attributes
8083 @cindex @code{minus} and attributes
8084 @cindex @code{mult} and attributes
8085 @cindex @code{div} and attributes
8086 @cindex @code{mod} and attributes
8087 @cindex @code{abs} and attributes
8088 @cindex @code{neg} and attributes
8089 @cindex @code{ashift} and attributes
8090 @cindex @code{lshiftrt} and attributes
8091 @cindex @code{ashiftrt} and attributes
8092 @item (le @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8093 @itemx (leu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8094 @itemx (lt @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8095 @itemx (ltu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8096 @itemx (gt @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8097 @itemx (gtu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8098 @itemx (ge @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8099 @itemx (geu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8100 @itemx (ne @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8101 @itemx (eq @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
8102 These tests are true if the indicated comparison of the two arithmetic
8103 expressions is true. Arithmetic expressions are formed with
8104 @code{plus}, @code{minus}, @code{mult}, @code{div}, @code{mod},
8105 @code{abs}, @code{neg}, @code{and}, @code{ior}, @code{xor}, @code{not},
8106 @code{ashift}, @code{lshiftrt}, and @code{ashiftrt} expressions.
8109 @code{const_int} and @code{symbol_ref} are always valid terms (@pxref{Insn
8110 Lengths},for additional forms). @code{symbol_ref} is a string
8111 denoting a C expression that yields an @code{int} when evaluated by the
8112 @samp{get_attr_@dots{}} routine. It should normally be a global
8116 @item (eq_attr @var{name} @var{value})
8117 @var{name} is a string specifying the name of an attribute.
8119 @var{value} is a string that is either a valid value for attribute
8120 @var{name}, a comma-separated list of values, or @samp{!} followed by a
8121 value or list. If @var{value} does not begin with a @samp{!}, this
8122 test is true if the value of the @var{name} attribute of the current
8123 insn is in the list specified by @var{value}. If @var{value} begins
8124 with a @samp{!}, this test is true if the attribute's value is
8125 @emph{not} in the specified list.
8130 (eq_attr "type" "load,store")
8137 (ior (eq_attr "type" "load") (eq_attr "type" "store"))
8140 If @var{name} specifies an attribute of @samp{alternative}, it refers to the
8141 value of the compiler variable @code{which_alternative}
8142 (@pxref{Output Statement}) and the values must be small integers. For
8146 (eq_attr "alternative" "2,3")
8153 (ior (eq (symbol_ref "which_alternative") (const_int 2))
8154 (eq (symbol_ref "which_alternative") (const_int 3)))
8157 Note that, for most attributes, an @code{eq_attr} test is simplified in cases
8158 where the value of the attribute being tested is known for all insns matching
8159 a particular pattern. This is by far the most common case.
8162 @item (attr_flag @var{name})
8163 The value of an @code{attr_flag} expression is true if the flag
8164 specified by @var{name} is true for the @code{insn} currently being
8167 @var{name} is a string specifying one of a fixed set of flags to test.
8168 Test the flags @code{forward} and @code{backward} to determine the
8169 direction of a conditional branch.
8171 This example describes a conditional branch delay slot which
8172 can be nullified for forward branches that are taken (annul-true) or
8173 for backward branches which are not taken (annul-false).
8176 (define_delay (eq_attr "type" "cbranch")
8177 [(eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
8178 (and (eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
8179 (attr_flag "forward"))
8180 (and (eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
8181 (attr_flag "backward"))])
8184 The @code{forward} and @code{backward} flags are false if the current
8185 @code{insn} being scheduled is not a conditional branch.
8187 @code{attr_flag} is only used during delay slot scheduling and has no
8188 meaning to other passes of the compiler.
8191 @item (attr @var{name})
8192 The value of another attribute is returned. This is most useful
8193 for numeric attributes, as @code{eq_attr} and @code{attr_flag}
8194 produce more efficient code for non-numeric attributes.
8200 @subsection Assigning Attribute Values to Insns
8201 @cindex tagging insns
8202 @cindex assigning attribute values to insns
8204 The value assigned to an attribute of an insn is primarily determined by
8205 which pattern is matched by that insn (or which @code{define_peephole}
8206 generated it). Every @code{define_insn} and @code{define_peephole} can
8207 have an optional last argument to specify the values of attributes for
8208 matching insns. The value of any attribute not specified in a particular
8209 insn is set to the default value for that attribute, as specified in its
8210 @code{define_attr}. Extensive use of default values for attributes
8211 permits the specification of the values for only one or two attributes
8212 in the definition of most insn patterns, as seen in the example in the
8215 The optional last argument of @code{define_insn} and
8216 @code{define_peephole} is a vector of expressions, each of which defines
8217 the value for a single attribute. The most general way of assigning an
8218 attribute's value is to use a @code{set} expression whose first operand is an
8219 @code{attr} expression giving the name of the attribute being set. The
8220 second operand of the @code{set} is an attribute expression
8221 (@pxref{Expressions}) giving the value of the attribute.
8223 When the attribute value depends on the @samp{alternative} attribute
8224 (i.e., which is the applicable alternative in the constraint of the
8225 insn), the @code{set_attr_alternative} expression can be used. It
8226 allows the specification of a vector of attribute expressions, one for
8230 When the generality of arbitrary attribute expressions is not required,
8231 the simpler @code{set_attr} expression can be used, which allows
8232 specifying a string giving either a single attribute value or a list
8233 of attribute values, one for each alternative.
8235 The form of each of the above specifications is shown below. In each case,
8236 @var{name} is a string specifying the attribute to be set.
8239 @item (set_attr @var{name} @var{value-string})
8240 @var{value-string} is either a string giving the desired attribute value,
8241 or a string containing a comma-separated list giving the values for
8242 succeeding alternatives. The number of elements must match the number
8243 of alternatives in the constraint of the insn pattern.
8245 Note that it may be useful to specify @samp{*} for some alternative, in
8246 which case the attribute will assume its default value for insns matching
8249 @findex set_attr_alternative
8250 @item (set_attr_alternative @var{name} [@var{value1} @var{value2} @dots{}])
8251 Depending on the alternative of the insn, the value will be one of the
8252 specified values. This is a shorthand for using a @code{cond} with
8253 tests on the @samp{alternative} attribute.
8256 @item (set (attr @var{name}) @var{value})
8257 The first operand of this @code{set} must be the special RTL expression
8258 @code{attr}, whose sole operand is a string giving the name of the
8259 attribute being set. @var{value} is the value of the attribute.
8262 The following shows three different ways of representing the same
8263 attribute value specification:
8266 (set_attr "type" "load,store,arith")
8268 (set_attr_alternative "type"
8269 [(const_string "load") (const_string "store")
8270 (const_string "arith")])
8273 (cond [(eq_attr "alternative" "1") (const_string "load")
8274 (eq_attr "alternative" "2") (const_string "store")]
8275 (const_string "arith")))
8279 @findex define_asm_attributes
8280 The @code{define_asm_attributes} expression provides a mechanism to
8281 specify the attributes assigned to insns produced from an @code{asm}
8282 statement. It has the form:
8285 (define_asm_attributes [@var{attr-sets}])
8289 where @var{attr-sets} is specified the same as for both the
8290 @code{define_insn} and the @code{define_peephole} expressions.
8292 These values will typically be the ``worst case'' attribute values. For
8293 example, they might indicate that the condition code will be clobbered.
8295 A specification for a @code{length} attribute is handled specially. The
8296 way to compute the length of an @code{asm} insn is to multiply the
8297 length specified in the expression @code{define_asm_attributes} by the
8298 number of machine instructions specified in the @code{asm} statement,
8299 determined by counting the number of semicolons and newlines in the
8300 string. Therefore, the value of the @code{length} attribute specified
8301 in a @code{define_asm_attributes} should be the maximum possible length
8302 of a single machine instruction.
8307 @subsection Example of Attribute Specifications
8308 @cindex attribute specifications example
8309 @cindex attribute specifications
8311 The judicious use of defaulting is important in the efficient use of
8312 insn attributes. Typically, insns are divided into @dfn{types} and an
8313 attribute, customarily called @code{type}, is used to represent this
8314 value. This attribute is normally used only to define the default value
8315 for other attributes. An example will clarify this usage.
8317 Assume we have a RISC machine with a condition code and in which only
8318 full-word operations are performed in registers. Let us assume that we
8319 can divide all insns into loads, stores, (integer) arithmetic
8320 operations, floating point operations, and branches.
8322 Here we will concern ourselves with determining the effect of an insn on
8323 the condition code and will limit ourselves to the following possible
8324 effects: The condition code can be set unpredictably (clobbered), not
8325 be changed, be set to agree with the results of the operation, or only
8326 changed if the item previously set into the condition code has been
8329 Here is part of a sample @file{md} file for such a machine:
8332 (define_attr "type" "load,store,arith,fp,branch" (const_string "arith"))
8334 (define_attr "cc" "clobber,unchanged,set,change0"
8335 (cond [(eq_attr "type" "load")
8336 (const_string "change0")
8337 (eq_attr "type" "store,branch")
8338 (const_string "unchanged")
8339 (eq_attr "type" "arith")
8340 (if_then_else (match_operand:SI 0 "" "")
8341 (const_string "set")
8342 (const_string "clobber"))]
8343 (const_string "clobber")))
8346 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,r,m")
8347 (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "r,m,r"))]
8353 [(set_attr "type" "arith,load,store")])
8356 Note that we assume in the above example that arithmetic operations
8357 performed on quantities smaller than a machine word clobber the condition
8358 code since they will set the condition code to a value corresponding to the
8364 @subsection Computing the Length of an Insn
8365 @cindex insn lengths, computing
8366 @cindex computing the length of an insn
8368 For many machines, multiple types of branch instructions are provided, each
8369 for different length branch displacements. In most cases, the assembler
8370 will choose the correct instruction to use. However, when the assembler
8371 cannot do so, GCC can when a special attribute, the @code{length}
8372 attribute, is defined. This attribute must be defined to have numeric
8373 values by specifying a null string in its @code{define_attr}.
8375 In the case of the @code{length} attribute, two additional forms of
8376 arithmetic terms are allowed in test expressions:
8379 @cindex @code{match_dup} and attributes
8380 @item (match_dup @var{n})
8381 This refers to the address of operand @var{n} of the current insn, which
8382 must be a @code{label_ref}.
8384 @cindex @code{pc} and attributes
8386 This refers to the address of the @emph{current} insn. It might have
8387 been more consistent with other usage to make this the address of the
8388 @emph{next} insn but this would be confusing because the length of the
8389 current insn is to be computed.
8392 @cindex @code{addr_vec}, length of
8393 @cindex @code{addr_diff_vec}, length of
8394 For normal insns, the length will be determined by value of the
8395 @code{length} attribute. In the case of @code{addr_vec} and
8396 @code{addr_diff_vec} insn patterns, the length is computed as
8397 the number of vectors multiplied by the size of each vector.
8399 Lengths are measured in addressable storage units (bytes).
8401 The following macros can be used to refine the length computation:
8404 @findex ADJUST_INSN_LENGTH
8405 @item ADJUST_INSN_LENGTH (@var{insn}, @var{length})
8406 If defined, modifies the length assigned to instruction @var{insn} as a
8407 function of the context in which it is used. @var{length} is an lvalue
8408 that contains the initially computed length of the insn and should be
8409 updated with the correct length of the insn.
8411 This macro will normally not be required. A case in which it is
8412 required is the ROMP@. On this machine, the size of an @code{addr_vec}
8413 insn must be increased by two to compensate for the fact that alignment
8417 @findex get_attr_length
8418 The routine that returns @code{get_attr_length} (the value of the
8419 @code{length} attribute) can be used by the output routine to
8420 determine the form of the branch instruction to be written, as the
8421 example below illustrates.
8423 As an example of the specification of variable-length branches, consider
8424 the IBM 360. If we adopt the convention that a register will be set to
8425 the starting address of a function, we can jump to labels within 4k of
8426 the start using a four-byte instruction. Otherwise, we need a six-byte
8427 sequence to load the address from memory and then branch to it.
8429 On such a machine, a pattern for a branch instruction might be specified
8435 (label_ref (match_operand 0 "" "")))]
8438 return (get_attr_length (insn) == 4
8439 ? "b %l0" : "l r15,=a(%l0); br r15");
8441 [(set (attr "length")
8442 (if_then_else (lt (match_dup 0) (const_int 4096))
8449 @node Constant Attributes
8450 @subsection Constant Attributes
8451 @cindex constant attributes
8453 A special form of @code{define_attr}, where the expression for the
8454 default value is a @code{const} expression, indicates an attribute that
8455 is constant for a given run of the compiler. Constant attributes may be
8456 used to specify which variety of processor is used. For example,
8459 (define_attr "cpu" "m88100,m88110,m88000"
8461 (cond [(symbol_ref "TARGET_88100") (const_string "m88100")
8462 (symbol_ref "TARGET_88110") (const_string "m88110")]
8463 (const_string "m88000"))))
8465 (define_attr "memory" "fast,slow"
8467 (if_then_else (symbol_ref "TARGET_FAST_MEM")
8468 (const_string "fast")
8469 (const_string "slow"))))
8472 The routine generated for constant attributes has no parameters as it
8473 does not depend on any particular insn. RTL expressions used to define
8474 the value of a constant attribute may use the @code{symbol_ref} form,
8475 but may not use either the @code{match_operand} form or @code{eq_attr}
8476 forms involving insn attributes.
8480 @node Mnemonic Attribute
8481 @subsection Mnemonic Attribute
8482 @cindex mnemonic attribute
8484 The @code{mnemonic} attribute is a string type attribute holding the
8485 instruction mnemonic for an insn alternative. The attribute values
8486 will automatically be generated by the machine description parser if
8487 there is an attribute definition in the md file:
8490 (define_attr "mnemonic" "unknown" (const_string "unknown"))
8493 The default value can be freely chosen as long as it does not collide
8494 with any of the instruction mnemonics. This value will be used
8495 whenever the machine description parser is not able to determine the
8496 mnemonic string. This might be the case for output templates
8497 containing more than a single instruction as in
8498 @code{"mvcle\t%0,%1,0\;jo\t.-4"}.
8500 The @code{mnemonic} attribute set is not generated automatically if the
8501 instruction string is generated via C code.
8503 An existing @code{mnemonic} attribute set in an insn definition will not
8504 be overriden by the md file parser. That way it is possible to
8505 manually set the instruction mnemonics for the cases where the md file
8506 parser fails to determine it automatically.
8508 The @code{mnemonic} attribute is useful for dealing with instruction
8509 specific properties in the pipeline description without defining
8510 additional insn attributes.
8513 (define_attr "ooo_expanded" ""
8514 (cond [(eq_attr "mnemonic" "dlr,dsgr,d,dsgf,stam,dsgfr,dlgr")
8522 @subsection Delay Slot Scheduling
8523 @cindex delay slots, defining
8525 The insn attribute mechanism can be used to specify the requirements for
8526 delay slots, if any, on a target machine. An instruction is said to
8527 require a @dfn{delay slot} if some instructions that are physically
8528 after the instruction are executed as if they were located before it.
8529 Classic examples are branch and call instructions, which often execute
8530 the following instruction before the branch or call is performed.
8532 On some machines, conditional branch instructions can optionally
8533 @dfn{annul} instructions in the delay slot. This means that the
8534 instruction will not be executed for certain branch outcomes. Both
8535 instructions that annul if the branch is true and instructions that
8536 annul if the branch is false are supported.
8538 Delay slot scheduling differs from instruction scheduling in that
8539 determining whether an instruction needs a delay slot is dependent only
8540 on the type of instruction being generated, not on data flow between the
8541 instructions. See the next section for a discussion of data-dependent
8542 instruction scheduling.
8544 @findex define_delay
8545 The requirement of an insn needing one or more delay slots is indicated
8546 via the @code{define_delay} expression. It has the following form:
8549 (define_delay @var{test}
8550 [@var{delay-1} @var{annul-true-1} @var{annul-false-1}
8551 @var{delay-2} @var{annul-true-2} @var{annul-false-2}
8555 @var{test} is an attribute test that indicates whether this
8556 @code{define_delay} applies to a particular insn. If so, the number of
8557 required delay slots is determined by the length of the vector specified
8558 as the second argument. An insn placed in delay slot @var{n} must
8559 satisfy attribute test @var{delay-n}. @var{annul-true-n} is an
8560 attribute test that specifies which insns may be annulled if the branch
8561 is true. Similarly, @var{annul-false-n} specifies which insns in the
8562 delay slot may be annulled if the branch is false. If annulling is not
8563 supported for that delay slot, @code{(nil)} should be coded.
8565 For example, in the common case where branch and call insns require
8566 a single delay slot, which may contain any insn other than a branch or
8567 call, the following would be placed in the @file{md} file:
8570 (define_delay (eq_attr "type" "branch,call")
8571 [(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)])
8574 Multiple @code{define_delay} expressions may be specified. In this
8575 case, each such expression specifies different delay slot requirements
8576 and there must be no insn for which tests in two @code{define_delay}
8577 expressions are both true.
8579 For example, if we have a machine that requires one delay slot for branches
8580 but two for calls, no delay slot can contain a branch or call insn,
8581 and any valid insn in the delay slot for the branch can be annulled if the
8582 branch is true, we might represent this as follows:
8585 (define_delay (eq_attr "type" "branch")
8586 [(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call")
8587 (eq_attr "type" "!branch,call")
8590 (define_delay (eq_attr "type" "call")
8591 [(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)
8592 (eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)])
8594 @c the above is *still* too long. --mew 4feb93
8598 @node Processor pipeline description
8599 @subsection Specifying processor pipeline description
8600 @cindex processor pipeline description
8601 @cindex processor functional units
8602 @cindex instruction latency time
8603 @cindex interlock delays
8604 @cindex data dependence delays
8605 @cindex reservation delays
8606 @cindex pipeline hazard recognizer
8607 @cindex automaton based pipeline description
8608 @cindex regular expressions
8609 @cindex deterministic finite state automaton
8610 @cindex automaton based scheduler
8614 To achieve better performance, most modern processors
8615 (super-pipelined, superscalar @acronym{RISC}, and @acronym{VLIW}
8616 processors) have many @dfn{functional units} on which several
8617 instructions can be executed simultaneously. An instruction starts
8618 execution if its issue conditions are satisfied. If not, the
8619 instruction is stalled until its conditions are satisfied. Such
8620 @dfn{interlock (pipeline) delay} causes interruption of the fetching
8621 of successor instructions (or demands nop instructions, e.g.@: for some
8624 There are two major kinds of interlock delays in modern processors.
8625 The first one is a data dependence delay determining @dfn{instruction
8626 latency time}. The instruction execution is not started until all
8627 source data have been evaluated by prior instructions (there are more
8628 complex cases when the instruction execution starts even when the data
8629 are not available but will be ready in given time after the
8630 instruction execution start). Taking the data dependence delays into
8631 account is simple. The data dependence (true, output, and
8632 anti-dependence) delay between two instructions is given by a
8633 constant. In most cases this approach is adequate. The second kind
8634 of interlock delays is a reservation delay. The reservation delay
8635 means that two instructions under execution will be in need of shared
8636 processors resources, i.e.@: buses, internal registers, and/or
8637 functional units, which are reserved for some time. Taking this kind
8638 of delay into account is complex especially for modern @acronym{RISC}
8641 The task of exploiting more processor parallelism is solved by an
8642 instruction scheduler. For a better solution to this problem, the
8643 instruction scheduler has to have an adequate description of the
8644 processor parallelism (or @dfn{pipeline description}). GCC
8645 machine descriptions describe processor parallelism and functional
8646 unit reservations for groups of instructions with the aid of
8647 @dfn{regular expressions}.
8649 The GCC instruction scheduler uses a @dfn{pipeline hazard recognizer} to
8650 figure out the possibility of the instruction issue by the processor
8651 on a given simulated processor cycle. The pipeline hazard recognizer is
8652 automatically generated from the processor pipeline description. The
8653 pipeline hazard recognizer generated from the machine description
8654 is based on a deterministic finite state automaton (@acronym{DFA}):
8655 the instruction issue is possible if there is a transition from one
8656 automaton state to another one. This algorithm is very fast, and
8657 furthermore, its speed is not dependent on processor
8658 complexity@footnote{However, the size of the automaton depends on
8659 processor complexity. To limit this effect, machine descriptions
8660 can split orthogonal parts of the machine description among several
8661 automata: but then, since each of these must be stepped independently,
8662 this does cause a small decrease in the algorithm's performance.}.
8664 @cindex automaton based pipeline description
8665 The rest of this section describes the directives that constitute
8666 an automaton-based processor pipeline description. The order of
8667 these constructions within the machine description file is not
8670 @findex define_automaton
8671 @cindex pipeline hazard recognizer
8672 The following optional construction describes names of automata
8673 generated and used for the pipeline hazards recognition. Sometimes
8674 the generated finite state automaton used by the pipeline hazard
8675 recognizer is large. If we use more than one automaton and bind functional
8676 units to the automata, the total size of the automata is usually
8677 less than the size of the single automaton. If there is no one such
8678 construction, only one finite state automaton is generated.
8681 (define_automaton @var{automata-names})
8684 @var{automata-names} is a string giving names of the automata. The
8685 names are separated by commas. All the automata should have unique names.
8686 The automaton name is used in the constructions @code{define_cpu_unit} and
8687 @code{define_query_cpu_unit}.
8689 @findex define_cpu_unit
8690 @cindex processor functional units
8691 Each processor functional unit used in the description of instruction
8692 reservations should be described by the following construction.
8695 (define_cpu_unit @var{unit-names} [@var{automaton-name}])
8698 @var{unit-names} is a string giving the names of the functional units
8699 separated by commas. Don't use name @samp{nothing}, it is reserved
8702 @var{automaton-name} is a string giving the name of the automaton with
8703 which the unit is bound. The automaton should be described in
8704 construction @code{define_automaton}. You should give
8705 @dfn{automaton-name}, if there is a defined automaton.
8707 The assignment of units to automata are constrained by the uses of the
8708 units in insn reservations. The most important constraint is: if a
8709 unit reservation is present on a particular cycle of an alternative
8710 for an insn reservation, then some unit from the same automaton must
8711 be present on the same cycle for the other alternatives of the insn
8712 reservation. The rest of the constraints are mentioned in the
8713 description of the subsequent constructions.
8715 @findex define_query_cpu_unit
8716 @cindex querying function unit reservations
8717 The following construction describes CPU functional units analogously
8718 to @code{define_cpu_unit}. The reservation of such units can be
8719 queried for an automaton state. The instruction scheduler never
8720 queries reservation of functional units for given automaton state. So
8721 as a rule, you don't need this construction. This construction could
8722 be used for future code generation goals (e.g.@: to generate
8723 @acronym{VLIW} insn templates).
8726 (define_query_cpu_unit @var{unit-names} [@var{automaton-name}])
8729 @var{unit-names} is a string giving names of the functional units
8730 separated by commas.
8732 @var{automaton-name} is a string giving the name of the automaton with
8733 which the unit is bound.
8735 @findex define_insn_reservation
8736 @cindex instruction latency time
8737 @cindex regular expressions
8739 The following construction is the major one to describe pipeline
8740 characteristics of an instruction.
8743 (define_insn_reservation @var{insn-name} @var{default_latency}
8744 @var{condition} @var{regexp})
8747 @var{default_latency} is a number giving latency time of the
8748 instruction. There is an important difference between the old
8749 description and the automaton based pipeline description. The latency
8750 time is used for all dependencies when we use the old description. In
8751 the automaton based pipeline description, the given latency time is only
8752 used for true dependencies. The cost of anti-dependencies is always
8753 zero and the cost of output dependencies is the difference between
8754 latency times of the producing and consuming insns (if the difference
8755 is negative, the cost is considered to be zero). You can always
8756 change the default costs for any description by using the target hook
8757 @code{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST} (@pxref{Scheduling}).
8759 @var{insn-name} is a string giving the internal name of the insn. The
8760 internal names are used in constructions @code{define_bypass} and in
8761 the automaton description file generated for debugging. The internal
8762 name has nothing in common with the names in @code{define_insn}. It is a
8763 good practice to use insn classes described in the processor manual.
8765 @var{condition} defines what RTL insns are described by this
8766 construction. You should remember that you will be in trouble if
8767 @var{condition} for two or more different
8768 @code{define_insn_reservation} constructions is TRUE for an insn. In
8769 this case what reservation will be used for the insn is not defined.
8770 Such cases are not checked during generation of the pipeline hazards
8771 recognizer because in general recognizing that two conditions may have
8772 the same value is quite difficult (especially if the conditions
8773 contain @code{symbol_ref}). It is also not checked during the
8774 pipeline hazard recognizer work because it would slow down the
8775 recognizer considerably.
8777 @var{regexp} is a string describing the reservation of the cpu's functional
8778 units by the instruction. The reservations are described by a regular
8779 expression according to the following syntax:
8782 regexp = regexp "," oneof
8785 oneof = oneof "|" allof
8788 allof = allof "+" repeat
8791 repeat = element "*" number
8794 element = cpu_function_unit_name
8803 @samp{,} is used for describing the start of the next cycle in
8807 @samp{|} is used for describing a reservation described by the first
8808 regular expression @strong{or} a reservation described by the second
8809 regular expression @strong{or} etc.
8812 @samp{+} is used for describing a reservation described by the first
8813 regular expression @strong{and} a reservation described by the
8814 second regular expression @strong{and} etc.
8817 @samp{*} is used for convenience and simply means a sequence in which
8818 the regular expression are repeated @var{number} times with cycle
8819 advancing (see @samp{,}).
8822 @samp{cpu_function_unit_name} denotes reservation of the named
8826 @samp{reservation_name} --- see description of construction
8827 @samp{define_reservation}.
8830 @samp{nothing} denotes no unit reservations.
8833 @findex define_reservation
8834 Sometimes unit reservations for different insns contain common parts.
8835 In such case, you can simplify the pipeline description by describing
8836 the common part by the following construction
8839 (define_reservation @var{reservation-name} @var{regexp})
8842 @var{reservation-name} is a string giving name of @var{regexp}.
8843 Functional unit names and reservation names are in the same name
8844 space. So the reservation names should be different from the
8845 functional unit names and can not be the reserved name @samp{nothing}.
8847 @findex define_bypass
8848 @cindex instruction latency time
8850 The following construction is used to describe exceptions in the
8851 latency time for given instruction pair. This is so called bypasses.
8854 (define_bypass @var{number} @var{out_insn_names} @var{in_insn_names}
8858 @var{number} defines when the result generated by the instructions
8859 given in string @var{out_insn_names} will be ready for the
8860 instructions given in string @var{in_insn_names}. Each of these
8861 strings is a comma-separated list of filename-style globs and
8862 they refer to the names of @code{define_insn_reservation}s.
8865 (define_bypass 1 "cpu1_load_*, cpu1_store_*" "cpu1_load_*")
8867 defines a bypass between instructions that start with
8868 @samp{cpu1_load_} or @samp{cpu1_store_} and those that start with
8871 @var{guard} is an optional string giving the name of a C function which
8872 defines an additional guard for the bypass. The function will get the
8873 two insns as parameters. If the function returns zero the bypass will
8874 be ignored for this case. The additional guard is necessary to
8875 recognize complicated bypasses, e.g.@: when the consumer is only an address
8876 of insn @samp{store} (not a stored value).
8878 If there are more one bypass with the same output and input insns, the
8879 chosen bypass is the first bypass with a guard in description whose
8880 guard function returns nonzero. If there is no such bypass, then
8881 bypass without the guard function is chosen.
8883 @findex exclusion_set
8884 @findex presence_set
8885 @findex final_presence_set
8887 @findex final_absence_set
8890 The following five constructions are usually used to describe
8891 @acronym{VLIW} processors, or more precisely, to describe a placement
8892 of small instructions into @acronym{VLIW} instruction slots. They
8893 can be used for @acronym{RISC} processors, too.
8896 (exclusion_set @var{unit-names} @var{unit-names})
8897 (presence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
8898 (final_presence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
8899 (absence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
8900 (final_absence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
8903 @var{unit-names} is a string giving names of functional units
8904 separated by commas.
8906 @var{patterns} is a string giving patterns of functional units
8907 separated by comma. Currently pattern is one unit or units
8908 separated by white-spaces.
8910 The first construction (@samp{exclusion_set}) means that each
8911 functional unit in the first string can not be reserved simultaneously
8912 with a unit whose name is in the second string and vice versa. For
8913 example, the construction is useful for describing processors
8914 (e.g.@: some SPARC processors) with a fully pipelined floating point
8915 functional unit which can execute simultaneously only single floating
8916 point insns or only double floating point insns.
8918 The second construction (@samp{presence_set}) means that each
8919 functional unit in the first string can not be reserved unless at
8920 least one of pattern of units whose names are in the second string is
8921 reserved. This is an asymmetric relation. For example, it is useful
8922 for description that @acronym{VLIW} @samp{slot1} is reserved after
8923 @samp{slot0} reservation. We could describe it by the following
8927 (presence_set "slot1" "slot0")
8930 Or @samp{slot1} is reserved only after @samp{slot0} and unit @samp{b0}
8931 reservation. In this case we could write
8934 (presence_set "slot1" "slot0 b0")
8937 The third construction (@samp{final_presence_set}) is analogous to
8938 @samp{presence_set}. The difference between them is when checking is
8939 done. When an instruction is issued in given automaton state
8940 reflecting all current and planned unit reservations, the automaton
8941 state is changed. The first state is a source state, the second one
8942 is a result state. Checking for @samp{presence_set} is done on the
8943 source state reservation, checking for @samp{final_presence_set} is
8944 done on the result reservation. This construction is useful to
8945 describe a reservation which is actually two subsequent reservations.
8946 For example, if we use
8949 (presence_set "slot1" "slot0")
8952 the following insn will be never issued (because @samp{slot1} requires
8953 @samp{slot0} which is absent in the source state).
8956 (define_reservation "insn_and_nop" "slot0 + slot1")
8959 but it can be issued if we use analogous @samp{final_presence_set}.
8961 The forth construction (@samp{absence_set}) means that each functional
8962 unit in the first string can be reserved only if each pattern of units
8963 whose names are in the second string is not reserved. This is an
8964 asymmetric relation (actually @samp{exclusion_set} is analogous to
8965 this one but it is symmetric). For example it might be useful in a
8966 @acronym{VLIW} description to say that @samp{slot0} cannot be reserved
8967 after either @samp{slot1} or @samp{slot2} have been reserved. This
8968 can be described as:
8971 (absence_set "slot0" "slot1, slot2")
8974 Or @samp{slot2} can not be reserved if @samp{slot0} and unit @samp{b0}
8975 are reserved or @samp{slot1} and unit @samp{b1} are reserved. In
8976 this case we could write
8979 (absence_set "slot2" "slot0 b0, slot1 b1")
8982 All functional units mentioned in a set should belong to the same
8985 The last construction (@samp{final_absence_set}) is analogous to
8986 @samp{absence_set} but checking is done on the result (state)
8987 reservation. See comments for @samp{final_presence_set}.
8989 @findex automata_option
8990 @cindex deterministic finite state automaton
8991 @cindex nondeterministic finite state automaton
8992 @cindex finite state automaton minimization
8993 You can control the generator of the pipeline hazard recognizer with
8994 the following construction.
8997 (automata_option @var{options})
9000 @var{options} is a string giving options which affect the generated
9001 code. Currently there are the following options:
9005 @dfn{no-minimization} makes no minimization of the automaton. This is
9006 only worth to do when we are debugging the description and need to
9007 look more accurately at reservations of states.
9010 @dfn{time} means printing time statistics about the generation of
9014 @dfn{stats} means printing statistics about the generated automata
9015 such as the number of DFA states, NDFA states and arcs.
9018 @dfn{v} means a generation of the file describing the result automata.
9019 The file has suffix @samp{.dfa} and can be used for the description
9020 verification and debugging.
9023 @dfn{w} means a generation of warning instead of error for
9024 non-critical errors.
9027 @dfn{no-comb-vect} prevents the automaton generator from generating
9028 two data structures and comparing them for space efficiency. Using
9029 a comb vector to represent transitions may be better, but it can be
9030 very expensive to construct. This option is useful if the build
9031 process spends an unacceptably long time in genautomata.
9034 @dfn{ndfa} makes nondeterministic finite state automata. This affects
9035 the treatment of operator @samp{|} in the regular expressions. The
9036 usual treatment of the operator is to try the first alternative and,
9037 if the reservation is not possible, the second alternative. The
9038 nondeterministic treatment means trying all alternatives, some of them
9039 may be rejected by reservations in the subsequent insns.
9042 @dfn{collapse-ndfa} modifies the behaviour of the generator when
9043 producing an automaton. An additional state transition to collapse a
9044 nondeterministic @acronym{NDFA} state to a deterministic @acronym{DFA}
9045 state is generated. It can be triggered by passing @code{const0_rtx} to
9046 state_transition. In such an automaton, cycle advance transitions are
9047 available only for these collapsed states. This option is useful for
9048 ports that want to use the @code{ndfa} option, but also want to use
9049 @code{define_query_cpu_unit} to assign units to insns issued in a cycle.
9052 @dfn{progress} means output of a progress bar showing how many states
9053 were generated so far for automaton being processed. This is useful
9054 during debugging a @acronym{DFA} description. If you see too many
9055 generated states, you could interrupt the generator of the pipeline
9056 hazard recognizer and try to figure out a reason for generation of the
9060 As an example, consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} machine which can
9061 issue three insns (two integer insns and one floating point insn) on
9062 the cycle but can finish only two insns. To describe this, we define
9063 the following functional units.
9066 (define_cpu_unit "i0_pipeline, i1_pipeline, f_pipeline")
9067 (define_cpu_unit "port0, port1")
9070 All simple integer insns can be executed in any integer pipeline and
9071 their result is ready in two cycles. The simple integer insns are
9072 issued into the first pipeline unless it is reserved, otherwise they
9073 are issued into the second pipeline. Integer division and
9074 multiplication insns can be executed only in the second integer
9075 pipeline and their results are ready correspondingly in 8 and 4
9076 cycles. The integer division is not pipelined, i.e.@: the subsequent
9077 integer division insn can not be issued until the current division
9078 insn finished. Floating point insns are fully pipelined and their
9079 results are ready in 3 cycles. Where the result of a floating point
9080 insn is used by an integer insn, an additional delay of one cycle is
9081 incurred. To describe all of this we could specify
9084 (define_cpu_unit "div")
9086 (define_insn_reservation "simple" 2 (eq_attr "type" "int")
9087 "(i0_pipeline | i1_pipeline), (port0 | port1)")
9089 (define_insn_reservation "mult" 4 (eq_attr "type" "mult")
9090 "i1_pipeline, nothing*2, (port0 | port1)")
9092 (define_insn_reservation "div" 8 (eq_attr "type" "div")
9093 "i1_pipeline, div*7, div + (port0 | port1)")
9095 (define_insn_reservation "float" 3 (eq_attr "type" "float")
9096 "f_pipeline, nothing, (port0 | port1))
9098 (define_bypass 4 "float" "simple,mult,div")
9101 To simplify the description we could describe the following reservation
9104 (define_reservation "finish" "port0|port1")
9107 and use it in all @code{define_insn_reservation} as in the following
9111 (define_insn_reservation "simple" 2 (eq_attr "type" "int")
9112 "(i0_pipeline | i1_pipeline), finish")
9118 @node Conditional Execution
9119 @section Conditional Execution
9120 @cindex conditional execution
9123 A number of architectures provide for some form of conditional
9124 execution, or predication. The hallmark of this feature is the
9125 ability to nullify most of the instructions in the instruction set.
9126 When the instruction set is large and not entirely symmetric, it
9127 can be quite tedious to describe these forms directly in the
9128 @file{.md} file. An alternative is the @code{define_cond_exec} template.
9130 @findex define_cond_exec
9133 [@var{predicate-pattern}]
9135 "@var{output-template}"
9136 "@var{optional-insn-attribues}")
9139 @var{predicate-pattern} is the condition that must be true for the
9140 insn to be executed at runtime and should match a relational operator.
9141 One can use @code{match_operator} to match several relational operators
9142 at once. Any @code{match_operand} operands must have no more than one
9145 @var{condition} is a C expression that must be true for the generated
9148 @findex current_insn_predicate
9149 @var{output-template} is a string similar to the @code{define_insn}
9150 output template (@pxref{Output Template}), except that the @samp{*}
9151 and @samp{@@} special cases do not apply. This is only useful if the
9152 assembly text for the predicate is a simple prefix to the main insn.
9153 In order to handle the general case, there is a global variable
9154 @code{current_insn_predicate} that will contain the entire predicate
9155 if the current insn is predicated, and will otherwise be @code{NULL}.
9157 @var{optional-insn-attributes} is an optional vector of attributes that gets
9158 appended to the insn attributes of the produced cond_exec rtx. It can
9159 be used to add some distinguishing attribute to cond_exec rtxs produced
9160 that way. An example usage would be to use this attribute in conjunction
9161 with attributes on the main pattern to disable particular alternatives under
9164 When @code{define_cond_exec} is used, an implicit reference to
9165 the @code{predicable} instruction attribute is made.
9166 @xref{Insn Attributes}. This attribute must be a boolean (i.e.@: have
9167 exactly two elements in its @var{list-of-values}), with the possible
9168 values being @code{no} and @code{yes}. The default and all uses in
9169 the insns must be a simple constant, not a complex expressions. It
9170 may, however, depend on the alternative, by using a comma-separated
9171 list of values. If that is the case, the port should also define an
9172 @code{enabled} attribute (@pxref{Disable Insn Alternatives}), which
9173 should also allow only @code{no} and @code{yes} as its values.
9175 For each @code{define_insn} for which the @code{predicable}
9176 attribute is true, a new @code{define_insn} pattern will be
9177 generated that matches a predicated version of the instruction.
9181 (define_insn "addsi"
9182 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "r")
9183 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
9184 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
9189 [(ne (match_operand:CC 0 "register_operand" "c")
9196 generates a new pattern
9201 (ne (match_operand:CC 3 "register_operand" "c") (const_int 0))
9202 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "r")
9203 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
9204 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r"))))]
9205 "(@var{test2}) && (@var{test1})"
9206 "(%3) add %2,%1,%0")
9212 @section RTL Templates Transformations
9213 @cindex define_subst
9215 For some hardware architectures there are common cases when the RTL
9216 templates for the instructions can be derived from the other RTL
9217 templates using simple transformations. E.g., @file{i386.md} contains
9218 an RTL template for the ordinary @code{sub} instruction---
9219 @code{*subsi_1}, and for the @code{sub} instruction with subsequent
9220 zero-extension---@code{*subsi_1_zext}. Such cases can be easily
9221 implemented by a single meta-template capable of generating a modified
9222 case based on the initial one:
9224 @findex define_subst
9226 (define_subst "@var{name}"
9227 [@var{input-template}]
9229 [@var{output-template}])
9231 @var{input-template} is a pattern describing the source RTL template,
9232 which will be transformed.
9234 @var{condition} is a C expression that is conjunct with the condition
9235 from the input-template to generate a condition to be used in the
9238 @var{output-template} is a pattern that will be used in the resulting
9241 @code{define_subst} mechanism is tightly coupled with the notion of the
9242 subst attribute (@pxref{Subst Iterators}). The use of
9243 @code{define_subst} is triggered by a reference to a subst attribute in
9244 the transforming RTL template. This reference initiates duplication of
9245 the source RTL template and substitution of the attributes with their
9246 values. The source RTL template is left unchanged, while the copy is
9247 transformed by @code{define_subst}. This transformation can fail in the
9248 case when the source RTL template is not matched against the
9249 input-template of the @code{define_subst}. In such case the copy is
9252 @code{define_subst} can be used only in @code{define_insn} and
9253 @code{define_expand}, it cannot be used in other expressions (e.g. in
9254 @code{define_insn_and_split}).
9257 * Define Subst Example:: Example of @code{define_subst} work.
9258 * Define Subst Pattern Matching:: Process of template comparison.
9259 * Define Subst Output Template:: Generation of output template.
9262 @node Define Subst Example
9263 @subsection @code{define_subst} Example
9264 @cindex define_subst
9266 To illustrate how @code{define_subst} works, let us examine a simple
9267 template transformation.
9269 Suppose there are two kinds of instructions: one that touches flags and
9270 the other that does not. The instructions of the second type could be
9271 generated with the following @code{define_subst}:
9274 (define_subst "add_clobber_subst"
9275 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "" "")
9276 (match_operand:SI 1 "" ""))]
9280 (clobber (reg:CC FLAGS_REG))]
9283 This @code{define_subst} can be applied to any RTL pattern containing
9284 @code{set} of mode SI and generates a copy with clobber when it is
9287 Assume there is an RTL template for a @code{max} instruction to be used
9288 in @code{define_subst} mentioned above:
9291 (define_insn "maxsi"
9292 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
9294 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
9295 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
9297 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
9301 To mark the RTL template for @code{define_subst} application,
9302 subst-attributes are used. They should be declared in advance:
9305 (define_subst_attr "add_clobber_name" "add_clobber_subst" "_noclobber" "_clobber")
9308 Here @samp{add_clobber_name} is the attribute name,
9309 @samp{add_clobber_subst} is the name of the corresponding
9310 @code{define_subst}, the third argument (@samp{_noclobber}) is the
9311 attribute value that would be substituted into the unchanged version of
9312 the source RTL template, and the last argument (@samp{_clobber}) is the
9313 value that would be substituted into the second, transformed,
9314 version of the RTL template.
9316 Once the subst-attribute has been defined, it should be used in RTL
9317 templates which need to be processed by the @code{define_subst}. So,
9318 the original RTL template should be changed:
9321 (define_insn "maxsi<add_clobber_name>"
9322 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
9324 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
9325 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
9327 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
9331 The result of the @code{define_subst} usage would look like the following:
9334 (define_insn "maxsi_noclobber"
9335 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
9337 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
9338 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
9340 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
9342 (define_insn "maxsi_clobber"
9343 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
9345 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
9346 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))
9347 (clobber (reg:CC FLAGS_REG))]
9349 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
9353 @node Define Subst Pattern Matching
9354 @subsection Pattern Matching in @code{define_subst}
9355 @cindex define_subst
9357 All expressions, allowed in @code{define_insn} or @code{define_expand},
9358 are allowed in the input-template of @code{define_subst}, except
9359 @code{match_par_dup}, @code{match_scratch}, @code{match_parallel}. The
9360 meanings of expressions in the input-template were changed:
9362 @code{match_operand} matches any expression (possibly, a subtree in
9363 RTL-template), if modes of the @code{match_operand} and this expression
9364 are the same, or mode of the @code{match_operand} is @code{VOIDmode}, or
9365 this expression is @code{match_dup}, @code{match_op_dup}. If the
9366 expression is @code{match_operand} too, and predicate of
9367 @code{match_operand} from the input pattern is not empty, then the
9368 predicates are compared. That can be used for more accurate filtering
9369 of accepted RTL-templates.
9371 @code{match_operator} matches common operators (like @code{plus},
9372 @code{minus}), @code{unspec}, @code{unspec_volatile} operators and
9373 @code{match_operator}s from the original pattern if the modes match and
9374 @code{match_operator} from the input pattern has the same number of
9375 operands as the operator from the original pattern.
9377 @node Define Subst Output Template
9378 @subsection Generation of output template in @code{define_subst}
9379 @cindex define_subst
9381 If all necessary checks for @code{define_subst} application pass, a new
9382 RTL-pattern, based on the output-template, is created to replace the old
9383 template. Like in input-patterns, meanings of some RTL expressions are
9384 changed when they are used in output-patterns of a @code{define_subst}.
9385 Thus, @code{match_dup} is used for copying the whole expression from the
9386 original pattern, which matched corresponding @code{match_operand} from
9389 @code{match_dup N} is used in the output template to be replaced with
9390 the expression from the original pattern, which matched
9391 @code{match_operand N} from the input pattern. As a consequence,
9392 @code{match_dup} cannot be used to point to @code{match_operand}s from
9393 the output pattern, it should always refer to a @code{match_operand}
9394 from the input pattern.
9396 In the output template one can refer to the expressions from the
9397 original pattern and create new ones. For instance, some operands could
9398 be added by means of standard @code{match_operand}.
9400 After replacing @code{match_dup} with some RTL-subtree from the original
9401 pattern, it could happen that several @code{match_operand}s in the
9402 output pattern have the same indexes. It is unknown, how many and what
9403 indexes would be used in the expression which would replace
9404 @code{match_dup}, so such conflicts in indexes are inevitable. To
9405 overcome this issue, @code{match_operands} and @code{match_operators},
9406 which were introduced into the output pattern, are renumerated when all
9407 @code{match_dup}s are replaced.
9409 Number of alternatives in @code{match_operand}s introduced into the
9410 output template @code{M} could differ from the number of alternatives in
9411 the original pattern @code{N}, so in the resultant pattern there would
9412 be @code{N*M} alternatives. Thus, constraints from the original pattern
9413 would be duplicated @code{N} times, constraints from the output pattern
9414 would be duplicated @code{M} times, producing all possible combinations.
9418 @node Constant Definitions
9419 @section Constant Definitions
9420 @cindex constant definitions
9421 @findex define_constants
9423 Using literal constants inside instruction patterns reduces legibility and
9424 can be a maintenance problem.
9426 To overcome this problem, you may use the @code{define_constants}
9427 expression. It contains a vector of name-value pairs. From that
9428 point on, wherever any of the names appears in the MD file, it is as
9429 if the corresponding value had been written instead. You may use
9430 @code{define_constants} multiple times; each appearance adds more
9431 constants to the table. It is an error to redefine a constant with
9434 To come back to the a29k load multiple example, instead of
9438 [(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
9439 [(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
9440 (match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
9442 (clobber (reg:SI 179))])]
9458 [(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
9459 [(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
9460 (match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
9462 (clobber (reg:SI R_CR))])]
9467 The constants that are defined with a define_constant are also output
9468 in the insn-codes.h header file as #defines.
9470 @cindex enumerations
9471 @findex define_c_enum
9472 You can also use the machine description file to define enumerations.
9473 Like the constants defined by @code{define_constant}, these enumerations
9474 are visible to both the machine description file and the main C code.
9476 The syntax is as follows:
9479 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [
9487 This definition causes the equivalent of the following C code to appear
9488 in @file{insn-constants.h}:
9495 @var{valuen} = @var{n}
9497 #define NUM_@var{cname}_VALUES (@var{n} + 1)
9500 where @var{cname} is the capitalized form of @var{name}.
9501 It also makes each @var{valuei} available in the machine description
9502 file, just as if it had been declared with:
9505 (define_constants [(@var{valuei} @var{i})])
9508 Each @var{valuei} is usually an upper-case identifier and usually
9509 begins with @var{cname}.
9511 You can split the enumeration definition into as many statements as
9512 you like. The above example is directly equivalent to:
9515 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [@var{value0}])
9516 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [@var{value1}])
9518 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [@var{valuen}])
9521 Splitting the enumeration helps to improve the modularity of each
9522 individual @code{.md} file. For example, if a port defines its
9523 synchronization instructions in a separate @file{sync.md} file,
9524 it is convenient to define all synchronization-specific enumeration
9525 values in @file{sync.md} rather than in the main @file{.md} file.
9527 Some enumeration names have special significance to GCC:
9531 @findex unspec_volatile
9532 If an enumeration called @code{unspecv} is defined, GCC will use it
9533 when printing out @code{unspec_volatile} expressions. For example:
9536 (define_c_enum "unspecv" [
9541 causes GCC to print @samp{(unspec_volatile @dots{} 0)} as:
9544 (unspec_volatile ... UNSPECV_BLOCKAGE)
9549 If an enumeration called @code{unspec} is defined, GCC will use
9550 it when printing out @code{unspec} expressions. GCC will also use
9551 it when printing out @code{unspec_volatile} expressions unless an
9552 @code{unspecv} enumeration is also defined. You can therefore
9553 decide whether to keep separate enumerations for volatile and
9554 non-volatile expressions or whether to use the same enumeration
9559 @anchor{define_enum}
9560 Another way of defining an enumeration is to use @code{define_enum}:
9563 (define_enum "@var{name}" [
9571 This directive implies:
9574 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [
9575 @var{cname}_@var{cvalue0}
9576 @var{cname}_@var{cvalue1}
9578 @var{cname}_@var{cvaluen}
9582 @findex define_enum_attr
9583 where @var{cvaluei} is the capitalized form of @var{valuei}.
9584 However, unlike @code{define_c_enum}, the enumerations defined
9585 by @code{define_enum} can be used in attribute specifications
9586 (@pxref{define_enum_attr}).
9591 @cindex iterators in @file{.md} files
9593 Ports often need to define similar patterns for more than one machine
9594 mode or for more than one rtx code. GCC provides some simple iterator
9595 facilities to make this process easier.
9598 * Mode Iterators:: Generating variations of patterns for different modes.
9599 * Code Iterators:: Doing the same for codes.
9600 * Int Iterators:: Doing the same for integers.
9601 * Subst Iterators:: Generating variations of patterns for define_subst.
9604 @node Mode Iterators
9605 @subsection Mode Iterators
9606 @cindex mode iterators in @file{.md} files
9608 Ports often need to define similar patterns for two or more different modes.
9613 If a processor has hardware support for both single and double
9614 floating-point arithmetic, the @code{SFmode} patterns tend to be
9615 very similar to the @code{DFmode} ones.
9618 If a port uses @code{SImode} pointers in one configuration and
9619 @code{DImode} pointers in another, it will usually have very similar
9620 @code{SImode} and @code{DImode} patterns for manipulating pointers.
9623 Mode iterators allow several patterns to be instantiated from one
9624 @file{.md} file template. They can be used with any type of
9625 rtx-based construct, such as a @code{define_insn},
9626 @code{define_split}, or @code{define_peephole2}.
9629 * Defining Mode Iterators:: Defining a new mode iterator.
9630 * Substitutions:: Combining mode iterators with substitutions
9631 * Examples:: Examples
9634 @node Defining Mode Iterators
9635 @subsubsection Defining Mode Iterators
9636 @findex define_mode_iterator
9638 The syntax for defining a mode iterator is:
9641 (define_mode_iterator @var{name} [(@var{mode1} "@var{cond1}") @dots{} (@var{moden} "@var{condn}")])
9644 This allows subsequent @file{.md} file constructs to use the mode suffix
9645 @code{:@var{name}}. Every construct that does so will be expanded
9646 @var{n} times, once with every use of @code{:@var{name}} replaced by
9647 @code{:@var{mode1}}, once with every use replaced by @code{:@var{mode2}},
9648 and so on. In the expansion for a particular @var{modei}, every
9649 C condition will also require that @var{condi} be true.
9654 (define_mode_iterator P [(SI "Pmode == SImode") (DI "Pmode == DImode")])
9657 defines a new mode suffix @code{:P}. Every construct that uses
9658 @code{:P} will be expanded twice, once with every @code{:P} replaced
9659 by @code{:SI} and once with every @code{:P} replaced by @code{:DI}.
9660 The @code{:SI} version will only apply if @code{Pmode == SImode} and
9661 the @code{:DI} version will only apply if @code{Pmode == DImode}.
9663 As with other @file{.md} conditions, an empty string is treated
9664 as ``always true''. @code{(@var{mode} "")} can also be abbreviated
9665 to @code{@var{mode}}. For example:
9668 (define_mode_iterator GPR [SI (DI "TARGET_64BIT")])
9671 means that the @code{:DI} expansion only applies if @code{TARGET_64BIT}
9672 but that the @code{:SI} expansion has no such constraint.
9674 Iterators are applied in the order they are defined. This can be
9675 significant if two iterators are used in a construct that requires
9676 substitutions. @xref{Substitutions}.
9679 @subsubsection Substitution in Mode Iterators
9680 @findex define_mode_attr
9682 If an @file{.md} file construct uses mode iterators, each version of the
9683 construct will often need slightly different strings or modes. For
9688 When a @code{define_expand} defines several @code{add@var{m}3} patterns
9689 (@pxref{Standard Names}), each expander will need to use the
9690 appropriate mode name for @var{m}.
9693 When a @code{define_insn} defines several instruction patterns,
9694 each instruction will often use a different assembler mnemonic.
9697 When a @code{define_insn} requires operands with different modes,
9698 using an iterator for one of the operand modes usually requires a specific
9699 mode for the other operand(s).
9702 GCC supports such variations through a system of ``mode attributes''.
9703 There are two standard attributes: @code{mode}, which is the name of
9704 the mode in lower case, and @code{MODE}, which is the same thing in
9705 upper case. You can define other attributes using:
9708 (define_mode_attr @var{name} [(@var{mode1} "@var{value1}") @dots{} (@var{moden} "@var{valuen}")])
9711 where @var{name} is the name of the attribute and @var{valuei}
9712 is the value associated with @var{modei}.
9714 When GCC replaces some @var{:iterator} with @var{:mode}, it will scan
9715 each string and mode in the pattern for sequences of the form
9716 @code{<@var{iterator}:@var{attr}>}, where @var{attr} is the name of a
9717 mode attribute. If the attribute is defined for @var{mode}, the whole
9718 @code{<@dots{}>} sequence will be replaced by the appropriate attribute
9721 For example, suppose an @file{.md} file has:
9724 (define_mode_iterator P [(SI "Pmode == SImode") (DI "Pmode == DImode")])
9725 (define_mode_attr load [(SI "lw") (DI "ld")])
9728 If one of the patterns that uses @code{:P} contains the string
9729 @code{"<P:load>\t%0,%1"}, the @code{SI} version of that pattern
9730 will use @code{"lw\t%0,%1"} and the @code{DI} version will use
9733 Here is an example of using an attribute for a mode:
9736 (define_mode_iterator LONG [SI DI])
9737 (define_mode_attr SHORT [(SI "HI") (DI "SI")])
9738 (define_insn @dots{}
9739 (sign_extend:LONG (match_operand:<LONG:SHORT> @dots{})) @dots{})
9742 The @code{@var{iterator}:} prefix may be omitted, in which case the
9743 substitution will be attempted for every iterator expansion.
9746 @subsubsection Mode Iterator Examples
9748 Here is an example from the MIPS port. It defines the following
9749 modes and attributes (among others):
9752 (define_mode_iterator GPR [SI (DI "TARGET_64BIT")])
9753 (define_mode_attr d [(SI "") (DI "d")])
9756 and uses the following template to define both @code{subsi3}
9760 (define_insn "sub<mode>3"
9761 [(set (match_operand:GPR 0 "register_operand" "=d")
9762 (minus:GPR (match_operand:GPR 1 "register_operand" "d")
9763 (match_operand:GPR 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
9766 [(set_attr "type" "arith")
9767 (set_attr "mode" "<MODE>")])
9770 This is exactly equivalent to:
9773 (define_insn "subsi3"
9774 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
9775 (minus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "d")
9776 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
9779 [(set_attr "type" "arith")
9780 (set_attr "mode" "SI")])
9782 (define_insn "subdi3"
9783 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
9784 (minus:DI (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" "d")
9785 (match_operand:DI 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
9788 [(set_attr "type" "arith")
9789 (set_attr "mode" "DI")])
9792 @node Code Iterators
9793 @subsection Code Iterators
9794 @cindex code iterators in @file{.md} files
9795 @findex define_code_iterator
9796 @findex define_code_attr
9798 Code iterators operate in a similar way to mode iterators. @xref{Mode Iterators}.
9803 (define_code_iterator @var{name} [(@var{code1} "@var{cond1}") @dots{} (@var{coden} "@var{condn}")])
9806 defines a pseudo rtx code @var{name} that can be instantiated as
9807 @var{codei} if condition @var{condi} is true. Each @var{codei}
9808 must have the same rtx format. @xref{RTL Classes}.
9810 As with mode iterators, each pattern that uses @var{name} will be
9811 expanded @var{n} times, once with all uses of @var{name} replaced by
9812 @var{code1}, once with all uses replaced by @var{code2}, and so on.
9813 @xref{Defining Mode Iterators}.
9815 It is possible to define attributes for codes as well as for modes.
9816 There are two standard code attributes: @code{code}, the name of the
9817 code in lower case, and @code{CODE}, the name of the code in upper case.
9818 Other attributes are defined using:
9821 (define_code_attr @var{name} [(@var{code1} "@var{value1}") @dots{} (@var{coden} "@var{valuen}")])
9824 Here's an example of code iterators in action, taken from the MIPS port:
9827 (define_code_iterator any_cond [unordered ordered unlt unge uneq ltgt unle ungt
9828 eq ne gt ge lt le gtu geu ltu leu])
9830 (define_expand "b<code>"
9832 (if_then_else (any_cond:CC (cc0)
9834 (label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
9838 gen_conditional_branch (operands, <CODE>);
9843 This is equivalent to:
9846 (define_expand "bunordered"
9848 (if_then_else (unordered:CC (cc0)
9850 (label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
9854 gen_conditional_branch (operands, UNORDERED);
9858 (define_expand "bordered"
9860 (if_then_else (ordered:CC (cc0)
9862 (label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
9866 gen_conditional_branch (operands, ORDERED);
9874 @subsection Int Iterators
9875 @cindex int iterators in @file{.md} files
9876 @findex define_int_iterator
9877 @findex define_int_attr
9879 Int iterators operate in a similar way to code iterators. @xref{Code Iterators}.
9884 (define_int_iterator @var{name} [(@var{int1} "@var{cond1}") @dots{} (@var{intn} "@var{condn}")])
9887 defines a pseudo integer constant @var{name} that can be instantiated as
9888 @var{inti} if condition @var{condi} is true. Each @var{int}
9889 must have the same rtx format. @xref{RTL Classes}. Int iterators can appear
9890 in only those rtx fields that have 'i' as the specifier. This means that
9891 each @var{int} has to be a constant defined using define_constant or
9894 As with mode and code iterators, each pattern that uses @var{name} will be
9895 expanded @var{n} times, once with all uses of @var{name} replaced by
9896 @var{int1}, once with all uses replaced by @var{int2}, and so on.
9897 @xref{Defining Mode Iterators}.
9899 It is possible to define attributes for ints as well as for codes and modes.
9900 Attributes are defined using:
9903 (define_int_attr @var{name} [(@var{int1} "@var{value1}") @dots{} (@var{intn} "@var{valuen}")])
9906 Here's an example of int iterators in action, taken from the ARM port:
9909 (define_int_iterator QABSNEG [UNSPEC_VQABS UNSPEC_VQNEG])
9911 (define_int_attr absneg [(UNSPEC_VQABS "abs") (UNSPEC_VQNEG "neg")])
9913 (define_insn "neon_vq<absneg><mode>"
9914 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
9915 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
9916 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
9919 "vq<absneg>.<V_s_elem>\t%<V_reg>0, %<V_reg>1"
9920 [(set_attr "type" "neon_vqneg_vqabs")]
9925 This is equivalent to:
9928 (define_insn "neon_vqabs<mode>"
9929 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
9930 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
9931 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
9934 "vqabs.<V_s_elem>\t%<V_reg>0, %<V_reg>1"
9935 [(set_attr "type" "neon_vqneg_vqabs")]
9938 (define_insn "neon_vqneg<mode>"
9939 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
9940 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
9941 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
9944 "vqneg.<V_s_elem>\t%<V_reg>0, %<V_reg>1"
9945 [(set_attr "type" "neon_vqneg_vqabs")]
9950 @node Subst Iterators
9951 @subsection Subst Iterators
9952 @cindex subst iterators in @file{.md} files
9953 @findex define_subst
9954 @findex define_subst_attr
9956 Subst iterators are special type of iterators with the following
9957 restrictions: they could not be declared explicitly, they always have
9958 only two values, and they do not have explicit dedicated name.
9959 Subst-iterators are triggered only when corresponding subst-attribute is
9960 used in RTL-pattern.
9962 Subst iterators transform templates in the following way: the templates
9963 are duplicated, the subst-attributes in these templates are replaced
9964 with the corresponding values, and a new attribute is implicitly added
9965 to the given @code{define_insn}/@code{define_expand}. The name of the
9966 added attribute matches the name of @code{define_subst}. Such
9967 attributes are declared implicitly, and it is not allowed to have a
9968 @code{define_attr} named as a @code{define_subst}.
9970 Each subst iterator is linked to a @code{define_subst}. It is declared
9971 implicitly by the first appearance of the corresponding
9972 @code{define_subst_attr}, and it is not allowed to define it explicitly.
9974 Declarations of subst-attributes have the following syntax:
9976 @findex define_subst_attr
9978 (define_subst_attr "@var{name}"
9980 "@var{no-subst-value}"
9981 "@var{subst-applied-value}")
9984 @var{name} is a string with which the given subst-attribute could be
9987 @var{subst-name} shows which @code{define_subst} should be applied to an
9988 RTL-template if the given subst-attribute is present in the
9991 @var{no-subst-value} is a value with which subst-attribute would be
9992 replaced in the first copy of the original RTL-template.
9994 @var{subst-applied-value} is a value with which subst-attribute would be
9995 replaced in the second copy of the original RTL-template.